blob: 81379c0222f68c5d8f92bae3efb1b33848617c37 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswell482202a2003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file was developed by the LLVM research group and is distributed under
6// the University of Illinois Open Source License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswell482202a2003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG This pass is where algebraic
12// simplification happens.
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner216c7b82003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattnerbfb1d032003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattnerbfb1d032003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattnerb4cfa7f2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner024f4ab2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +000043#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
44#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +000046#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +000047#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +000048#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000049#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattner22d00a82005-08-02 19:16:58 +000050#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +000051#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattner3d27be12006-08-27 12:54:02 +000052#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +000053#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +000054#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner7907e5f2007-02-15 19:41:52 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer7c16caa2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +000058#include <algorithm>
Reid Spencer755d0e72007-03-26 17:44:01 +000059#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000060using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +000061using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeke960707c2003-11-11 22:41:34 +000062
Chris Lattner79a42ac2006-12-19 21:40:18 +000063STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
64STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
65STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
66STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
67STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnerbf3a0992002-10-01 22:38:41 +000068
Chris Lattner79a42ac2006-12-19 21:40:18 +000069namespace {
Chris Lattner4a4c7fe2006-06-28 22:08:15 +000070 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
71 : public FunctionPass,
72 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000073 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +000074 std::vector<Instruction*> Worklist;
75 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +000076 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattner8258b442007-03-04 04:27:24 +000077 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 public:
79 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
80 /// isn't already in it.
81 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
82 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())))
83 Worklist.push_back(I);
84 }
85
86 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
87 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
88 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
89 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
90
91 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
92 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
93
94 WorklistMap.erase(It);
95 }
96
97 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
98 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
99 Worklist.pop_back();
100 WorklistMap.erase(I);
101 return I;
102 }
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000103
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000104
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000105 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
106 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
107 /// now.
108 ///
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000109 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000110 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000111 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000112 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000113 }
114
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000115 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
116 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
117 ///
118 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
119 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
120 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i)))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000121 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000122 }
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000123
124 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
125 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
126 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
127 ///
128 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
129 ///
130 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
131 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
132
133 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
134 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000135 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000136 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
137 I.setOperand(i, UndefValue::get(Op->getType()));
138 }
139
140 return R;
141 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000142
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000143 public:
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000144 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000145
146 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000147
Chris Lattnerf12cc842002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000148 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000149 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersona6968f82006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000150 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattner820d9712002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000151 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattnerf12cc842002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000152 }
153
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000154 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
155
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000156 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
157 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
158 // Return Value:
159 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000160 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000161 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000162 //
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000163 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
164 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
165 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000166 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
167 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
168 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
169 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000171 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
172 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
175 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000176 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
178 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000179 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000183 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
184 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
185 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000186
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000187 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
188 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000189 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000190 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000191 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
192 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
193 Instruction *visitTrunc(CastInst &CI);
194 Instruction *visitZExt(CastInst &CI);
195 Instruction *visitSExt(CastInst &CI);
196 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI);
197 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
198 Instruction *visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI);
199 Instruction *visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI);
200 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
201 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
202 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
203 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI);
204 Instruction *visitBitCast(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000205 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
206 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000207 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000208 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000210 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
211 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000212 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000213 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000214 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000215 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000216 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000217 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000218 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000219 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000220 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000221
222 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000223 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000224
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000225 private:
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000226 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000227 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
228
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000229 public:
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000230 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
231 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
232 //
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000233 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattner65217ff2002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000234 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
235 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000236 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
237 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000238 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000239 return New;
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000240 }
241
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000242 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
243 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
244 /// cast.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000245 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
246 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000247 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000248
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000249 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000250 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000251
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000252 Instruction *C = CastInst::create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000253 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000254 return C;
255 }
256
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000257 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
258 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
259 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
260 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
261 // modified.
262 //
263 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000264 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000265 if (&I != V) {
266 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
267 return &I;
268 } else {
269 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
270 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000271 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000272 return &I;
273 }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000274 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000275
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000276 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
277 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
278 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
279 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
280 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
281 //
282 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
283 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
284 if (Old != New)
285 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
286 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000287 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000288 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000289 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000290 return true;
291 }
292
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000293 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
294 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
295 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
296 // this function.
297 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
298 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
299 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000300 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner95307542004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000301 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000302 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
303 }
304
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000305 private:
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000306 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
307 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
308 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
309 ///
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000310 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
311 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000312 Instruction *InsertBefore);
313
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000314 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
315 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000316 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000317
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000318 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
319 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
320 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
321
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000322 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
323 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000324 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
325 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
326 unsigned Depth = 0);
327
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000328 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
329 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
330
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000331 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
332 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
333 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
334 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
335
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000336 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
337 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
338 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
339 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000340 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
341
342
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000343 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
344 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000345
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000346 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000347 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000348 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000349 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +0000350 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(CastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000351 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
352
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000353 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000354 };
Chris Lattnerb28b6802002-07-23 18:06:35 +0000355
Chris Lattnerc2d3d312006-08-27 22:42:52 +0000356 RegisterPass<InstCombiner> X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000357}
358
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000359// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000360// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000361static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
362 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
363 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000364 return 3;
365 return 4;
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000366 }
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000367 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
368 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000369}
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000370
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000371// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
372// it.
373static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000374 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000375}
376
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000377// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
378// though a va_arg area...
379static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000380 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
381 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
382 return Type::Int32Ty;
383 } else if (Ty == Type::FloatTy)
384 return Type::DoubleTy;
385 return Ty;
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000386}
387
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000388/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
389/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
390static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
391 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000392 return I->getOperand(0);
393 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000394 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000395 return CE->getOperand(0);
396 return 0;
397}
398
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000399/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
400/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000401static Instruction::CastOps
402isEliminableCastPair(
403 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
404 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
405 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
406 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
407) {
408
409 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
410 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000411
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000412 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
413 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
414 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000415
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000416 return Instruction::CastOps(
417 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
418 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000419}
420
421/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
422/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
423/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000424static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
425 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000426 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
427
Chris Lattner99155be2006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000428 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000429 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000430 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000431 return false;
432 return true;
433}
434
435/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
436/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
437/// casts that are known to not do anything...
438///
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000439Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
440 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000441 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
442 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
443 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000444 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000445
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000446 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000447}
448
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000449// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
450// operators:
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000451//
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000452// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
453// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
454// binary operators.
455//
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000456// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
457// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000458//
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000459bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000460 bool Changed = false;
461 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
462 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000463
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000464 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
465 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000466 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
467 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
468 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner34428442003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000469 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
470 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
471 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000472 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
473 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
474 return true;
475 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
476 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
477 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
478 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
479 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
480
481 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner34428442003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000482 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000483 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
484 Op1->getOperand(0),
485 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000486 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000487 I.setOperand(0, New);
488 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
489 return true;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000490 }
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000491 }
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000492 return Changed;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000493}
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000494
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000495/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
496/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
497/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
498bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
499 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
500 return false;
501 I.swapOperands();
502 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
503 return true;
504}
505
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000506// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
507// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000508//
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000509static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
510 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000511 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000512
Chris Lattner9ad0d552004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000513 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
514 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
515 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000516 return 0;
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000517}
518
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000519static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
520 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000521 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000522
523 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000524 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Chris Lattnerc8e7e292004-06-10 02:12:35 +0000525 return ConstantExpr::getNot(C);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000526 return 0;
527}
528
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000529// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
530// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000531// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
532// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000533//
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000534static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000535 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000536 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000537 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner970136362004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000538 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000539 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000540 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner970136362004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000541 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000542 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng4961cf12007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000543 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000544 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng4961cf12007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000545 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000546 return I->getOperand(0);
547 }
548 }
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000549 return 0;
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000550}
Chris Lattner31ae8632002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000551
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000552/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
553/// expression, return it.
554static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
555 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
556 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
557 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
558 return cast<User>(V);
559 return false;
560}
561
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000562/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000563static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer624766f2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000564 APInt Val(C->getValue());
565 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000566}
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000567/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000568static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer624766f2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000569 APInt Val(C->getValue());
570 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000571}
572/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
573static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
574 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
575}
576/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
577static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
578 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
579}
580/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
581static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
582 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
583}
584/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
585static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
586 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000587}
588
Chris Lattner4534dd592006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000589/// ComputeMaskedBits - Determine which of the bits specified in Mask are
590/// known to be either zero or one and return them in the KnownZero/KnownOne
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000591/// bit sets. This code only analyzes bits in Mask, in order to short-circuit
592/// processing.
593/// NOTE: we cannot consider 'undef' to be "IsZero" here. The problem is that
594/// we cannot optimize based on the assumption that it is zero without changing
595/// it to be an explicit zero. If we don't change it to zero, other code could
596/// optimized based on the contradictory assumption that it is non-zero.
597/// Because instcombine aggressively folds operations with undef args anyway,
598/// this won't lose us code quality.
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +0000599static void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000600 APInt& KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000601 assert(V && "No Value?");
602 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000603 uint32_t BitWidth = Mask.getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000604 assert(cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000605 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000606 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000607 "V, Mask, KnownOne and KnownZero should have same BitWidth");
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000608 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
609 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000610 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & Mask;
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000611 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & Mask;
612 return;
613 }
614
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000615 if (Depth == 6 || Mask == 0)
616 return; // Limit search depth.
617
618 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
619 if (!I) return;
620
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000621 KnownZero.clear(); KnownOne.clear(); // Don't know anything.
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000622 APInt KnownZero2(KnownZero), KnownOne2(KnownOne);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000623
624 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000625 case Instruction::And: {
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000626 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
627 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000628 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownZero);
629 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000630 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
631 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
632
633 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
634 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
635 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
636 KnownZero |= KnownZero2;
637 return;
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000638 }
639 case Instruction::Or: {
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000640 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000641 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownOne);
642 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000643 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
644 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
645
646 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
647 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
648 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
649 KnownOne |= KnownOne2;
650 return;
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000651 }
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000652 case Instruction::Xor: {
653 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
654 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
655 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
656 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
657
658 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
659 APInt KnownZeroOut = (KnownZero & KnownZero2) | (KnownOne & KnownOne2);
660 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
661 KnownOne = (KnownZero & KnownOne2) | (KnownOne & KnownZero2);
662 KnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
663 return;
664 }
665 case Instruction::Select:
666 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(2), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
667 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
668 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
669 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
670
671 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
672 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
673 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
674 return;
675 case Instruction::FPTrunc:
676 case Instruction::FPExt:
677 case Instruction::FPToUI:
678 case Instruction::FPToSI:
679 case Instruction::SIToFP:
680 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
681 case Instruction::UIToFP:
682 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
683 return; // Can't work with floating point or pointers
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000684 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000685 // All these have integer operands
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000686 uint32_t SrcBitWidth =
687 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000688 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
689 MaskIn.zext(SrcBitWidth);
690 KnownZero.zext(SrcBitWidth);
691 KnownOne.zext(SrcBitWidth);
692 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000693 KnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
694 KnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000695 return;
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000696 }
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000697 case Instruction::BitCast: {
698 const Type *SrcTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
699 if (SrcTy->isInteger()) {
700 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
701 return;
702 }
703 break;
704 }
705 case Instruction::ZExt: {
706 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
707 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000708 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000709
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000710 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
711 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
712 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
713 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
714 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000715 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
716 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000717 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
718 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000719 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000720 return;
721 }
722 case Instruction::SExt: {
723 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
724 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000725 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000726
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000727 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
728 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
729 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
730 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
731 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000732 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000733 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
734 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000735
736 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
737 // top bits of the result.
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000738 if (KnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known zero
Zhou Sheng117477e2007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000739 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000740 else if (KnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known set
Zhou Sheng117477e2007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000741 KnownOne |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000742 return;
743 }
744 case Instruction::Shl:
745 // (shl X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (X & C2 >>u C1) == 0
746 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000747 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000748 APInt Mask2(Mask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
749 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000750 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Shengb3e00c42007-03-12 05:44:52 +0000751 KnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
752 KnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
Reid Spencer624766f2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000753 KnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt); // low bits known 0
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000754 return;
755 }
756 break;
757 case Instruction::LShr:
758 // (ushr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
759 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
760 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000761 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000762
763 // Unsigned shift right.
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000764 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
765 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000766 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
767 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
768 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000769 // high bits known zero.
770 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000771 return;
772 }
773 break;
774 case Instruction::AShr:
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000775 // (ashr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000776 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
777 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000778 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000779
780 // Signed shift right.
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000781 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
782 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000783 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
784 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
785 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
786
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000787 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
788 if (KnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known zero.
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000789 KnownZero |= HighBits;
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000790 else if (KnownOne[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known one.
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000791 KnownOne |= HighBits;
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000792 return;
793 }
794 break;
795 }
796}
797
Reid Spencerbb5741f2007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000798/// MaskedValueIsZero - Return true if 'V & Mask' is known to be zero. We use
799/// this predicate to simplify operations downstream. Mask is known to be zero
800/// for bits that V cannot have.
801static bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt& Mask, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Shengbe171ee2007-03-12 16:54:56 +0000802 APInt KnownZero(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0), KnownOne(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0);
Reid Spencerbb5741f2007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000803 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
804 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
805 return (KnownZero & Mask) == Mask;
806}
807
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000808/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
809/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
810/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
811/// constant and return true.
812static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencerd9281782007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000813 APInt Demanded) {
814 assert(I && "No instruction?");
815 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
816
817 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
818 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
819 if (!OpC) return false;
820
821 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
822 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
823 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
824 return false;
825
826 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
827 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
828 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
829 return true;
830}
831
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000832// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
833// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
834// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
835// min/max.
836static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000837 const APInt& KnownZero,
838 const APInt& KnownOne,
839 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
840 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
841 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
842 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
843 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
844 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000845 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000846
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000847 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000848
849 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
850 // bit if it is unknown.
851 Min = KnownOne;
852 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
853
Zhou Shengc2d33092007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000854 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000855 Min |= SignBit;
856 Max &= ~SignBit;
857 }
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000858}
859
860// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
861// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
862// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
863// min/max.
864static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000865 const APInt& KnownZero,
866 const APInt& KnownOne,
867 APInt& Min,
868 APInt& Max) {
869 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
870 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
871 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
872 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
873 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000874 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000875
876 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
877 Min = KnownOne;
878 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
879 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
880}
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000881
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000882/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
883/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
884/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
885/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
886/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
887/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
888/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
889/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
890/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
891/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
892/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
893/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
894/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
895/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
896/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
897bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
898 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
899 unsigned Depth) {
900 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
901 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
902 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
903 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
904 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
905 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
906 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
907 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
908 must have same BitWidth");
909 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
910 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
911 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
912 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
913 return false;
914 }
915
Zhou Shengb9128442007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000916 KnownZero.clear();
917 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000918 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
919 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
920 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
921 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
922 return false;
923 }
924 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
925 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
926 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
927 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
928 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
929 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
930 return false;
931 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
932 return false;
933 }
934
935 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
936 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
937
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000938 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
939 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
940 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
941 default: break;
942 case Instruction::And:
943 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
944 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
945 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
946 return true;
947 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
948 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
949
950 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
951 // LHS.
952 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
953 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
954 return true;
955 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
956 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
957
958 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
959 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
960 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
961 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
962 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
963 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
964 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
965 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
966
967 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
968 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
969 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
970
971 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
972 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
973 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
974
975 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
976 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
977 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
978 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
979 break;
980 case Instruction::Or:
981 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
982 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
983 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
984 return true;
985 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
986 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
987 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
988 // LHS.
989 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
990 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
991 return true;
992 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
993 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
994
995 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
996 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
997 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
998 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
999 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1000 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
1001 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
1002 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1003
1004 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
1005 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
1006 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
1007 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
1008 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1009 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
1010 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
1011 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1012
1013 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1014 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1015 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1016
1017 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
1018 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1019 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
1020 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
1021 break;
1022 case Instruction::Xor: {
1023 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1024 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1025 return true;
1026 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1027 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1028 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1029 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1030 return true;
1031 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1032 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1033
1034 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1035 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
1036 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1037 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1038 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1039 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1040
1041 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1042 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1043 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1044 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1045 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1046 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1047
1048 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1049 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1050 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
1051 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1052 Instruction *Or =
1053 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1054 I->getName());
1055 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1056 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1057 }
1058
1059 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1060 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1061 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1062 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1063 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1064 // all known
1065 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
1066 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
1067 Instruction *And =
1068 BinaryOperator::createAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
1069 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
1070 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
1071 }
1072 }
1073
1074 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1075 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
1076 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1077 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1078
1079 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1080 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1081 break;
1082 }
1083 case Instruction::Select:
1084 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
1085 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1086 return true;
1087 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1088 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1089 return true;
1090 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1091 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1092 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1093 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1094
1095 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
1096 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1097 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1098 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
1099 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1100
1101 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1102 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1103 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1104 break;
1105 case Instruction::Trunc: {
1106 uint32_t truncBf =
1107 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001108 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1109 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1110 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1111 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1112 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001113 return true;
1114 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1115 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1116 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1117 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1118 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1119 break;
1120 }
1121 case Instruction::BitCast:
1122 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1123 return false;
1124
1125 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1126 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1127 return true;
1128 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1129 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1130 break;
1131 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1132 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1133 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001134 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001135
1136 DemandedMask &= SrcTy->getMask().zext(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng444af492007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001137 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1138 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1139 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001140 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1141 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001142 return true;
1143 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1144 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1145 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1146 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1147 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1148 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001149 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001150 break;
1151 }
1152 case Instruction::SExt: {
1153 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1154 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001155 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001156
1157 // Get the sign bit for the source type
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001158 APInt InSignBit(APInt::getSignBit(SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001159 InSignBit.zext(BitWidth);
1160 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001161 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001162
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001163 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001164 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1165 // bit is demanded.
1166 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
1167 InputDemandedBits |= InSignBit;
1168
Zhou Sheng444af492007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001169 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1170 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1171 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001172 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1173 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001174 return true;
1175 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1176 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1177 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1178 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1179 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1180
1181 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1182 // top bits of the result.
1183
1184 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1185 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001186 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001187 {
1188 // Convert to ZExt cast
1189 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1190 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001191 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001192 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001193 }
1194 break;
1195 }
1196 case Instruction::Add: {
1197 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1198 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1199 // either.
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001200 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001201
1202 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1203 // we can do.
1204 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1205 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1206 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1207 if (RHS->isZero())
1208 break;
1209
1210 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1211 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001212 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001213
1214 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1215 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1216 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1217 return true;
1218
1219 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1220 // the constant.
1221 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1222 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1223
1224 // Avoid excess work.
1225 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1226 break;
1227
1228 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1229 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1230 Instruction *Or =
1231 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1232 I->getName());
1233 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1234 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1235 }
1236
1237 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1238 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1239 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1240 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1241 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1242
1243 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1244 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1245 // this scan.
Zhou Sheng4f164022007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001246 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1247 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001248
1249 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1250
1251 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1252 // other, and there is no input carry.
1253 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1254 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1255
1256 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1257 // is no input carry.
1258 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1259 } else {
1260 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1261 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001262 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001263 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1264 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001265 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001266 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1267 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1268 return true;
1269 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1270 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1271 return true;
1272 }
1273 }
1274 break;
1275 }
1276 case Instruction::Sub:
1277 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1278 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001279 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001280 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1281 // significant bit and all those below it.
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001282 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001283 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001284 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1285 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1286 return true;
1287 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1288 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1289 return true;
1290 }
1291 break;
1292 case Instruction::Shl:
1293 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001294 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001295 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1296 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001297 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1298 return true;
1299 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1300 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1301 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1302 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1303 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengd8c645b2007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001304 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Sheng23f7a1c2007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001305 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001306 }
1307 break;
1308 case Instruction::LShr:
1309 // For a logical shift right
1310 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001311 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001312
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001313 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001314 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1315 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001316 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1317 return true;
1318 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1319 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001320 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1321 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengd8c645b2007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001322 if (ShiftAmt) {
1323 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001324 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengd8c645b2007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001325 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1326 }
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001327 }
1328 break;
1329 case Instruction::AShr:
1330 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1331 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1332 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1333 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1334 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1335 // Perform the logical shift right.
1336 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1337 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1338 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1339 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1340 }
1341
1342 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001343 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001344
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001345 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001346 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001347 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001348 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001349 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1350 return true;
1351 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1352 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1353 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001354 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001355 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1356 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1357
1358 // Handle the sign bits.
1359 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1360 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1361 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1362
1363 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1364 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shenga4475572007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001365 if (RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001366 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1367 // Perform the logical shift right.
1368 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1369 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1370 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1371 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1372 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1373 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1374 }
1375 }
1376 break;
1377 }
1378
1379 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1380 // constant.
1381 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1382 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1383 return false;
1384}
1385
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001386
1387/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1388/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1389/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1390/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1391///
1392/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1393/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1394/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1395Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1396 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1397 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001398 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001399 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1400 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1401 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1402 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1403
1404 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1405 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1406 UndefElts = EltMask;
1407 return 0;
1408 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1409 UndefElts = EltMask;
1410 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1411 }
1412
1413 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001414 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1415 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001416 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1417
1418 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1419 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1420 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1421 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1422 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1423 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1424 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1425 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1426 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1427 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1428 }
1429
1430 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001431 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001432 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1433 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001434 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001435 // set to undef.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001436 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001437 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1438 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1439 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1440 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1441 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1442 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001443 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001444 }
1445
1446 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1447 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1448 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1449 return false;
1450 }
1451 return false;
1452 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1453 return false;
1454 }
1455
1456 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1457 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1458
1459 bool MadeChange = false;
1460 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1461 Value *TmpV;
1462 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1463 default: break;
1464
1465 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1466 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1467 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001468 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001469 if (Idx == 0) {
1470 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1471 // which elt is getting updated.
1472 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1473 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1474 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1475 break;
1476 }
1477
1478 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1479 // insertelement.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001480 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001481 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1482 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1483
1484 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1485 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1486 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1487 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1488 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1489 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1490
1491 // The inserted element is defined.
1492 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1493 break;
1494 }
1495
1496 case Instruction::And:
1497 case Instruction::Or:
1498 case Instruction::Xor:
1499 case Instruction::Add:
1500 case Instruction::Sub:
1501 case Instruction::Mul:
1502 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1503 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1504 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1505 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1506 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1507 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1508 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1509
1510 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1511 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1512 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1513 break;
1514
1515 case Instruction::Call: {
1516 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1517 if (!II) break;
1518 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1519 default: break;
1520
1521 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1522 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1523 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1524 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1525 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1526 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1527 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1528 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1529 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1530 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1531 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1532 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1533 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1534 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1535 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1536 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1537
1538 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1539 // scalarize it now.
1540 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1541 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1542 default: break;
1543 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1544 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1545 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1546 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1547 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1548 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1549 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1550 // Extract the element as scalars.
1551 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1552 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1553
1554 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1555 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1556 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1557 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1558 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, RHS,
1559 II->getName()), *II);
1560 break;
1561 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1562 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1563 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, RHS,
1564 II->getName()), *II);
1565 break;
1566 }
1567
1568 Instruction *New =
1569 new InsertElementInst(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1570 II->getName());
1571 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1572 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1573 return New;
1574 }
1575 }
1576
1577 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1578 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1579 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1580 break;
1581 }
1582 break;
1583 }
1584 }
1585 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1586}
1587
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001588/// @returns true if the specified compare instruction is
1589/// true when both operands are equal...
1590/// @brief Determine if the ICmpInst returns true if both operands are equal
1591static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst &ICI) {
1592 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = ICI.getPredicate();
1593 return pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
1594 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
1595 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
1596}
1597
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001598/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1599/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1600/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1601/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1602/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1603/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1604/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1605///
1606template<typename Functor>
1607Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
1608 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1609 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1610
1611 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1612 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1613 return F.apply(Root);
1614
1615 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1616 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001617 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001618 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1619 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1620
1621 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1622 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1623 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1624 ShouldApply = true;
1625 }
1626
1627 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1628 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1629 if (ShouldApply) {
1630 BasicBlock *BB = Root.getParent();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001631
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001632 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1633 // and perform the reassociation.
1634 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1635
1636 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1637 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1638
1639 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1640 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001641 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001642 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1643 return 0;
1644 }
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001645 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001646 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001647 TmpLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(TmpLHSI);
1648 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
1649 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, TmpLHSI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
1650 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001651
1652 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1653 // get to LHSI.
1654 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1655 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001656 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1657 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
1658 NextLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(NextLHSI);
1659 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, NextLHSI);
1660 ARI = NextLHSI;
1661
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001662 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1663 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1664 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1665 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1666 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001667
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001668 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1669 // the transformation...
1670 return F.apply(Root);
1671 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001672
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001673 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1674 }
1675 return 0;
1676}
1677
1678
1679// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
1680struct AddRHS {
1681 Value *RHS;
1682 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1683 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1684 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00001685 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001686 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001687 }
1688};
1689
1690// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1691// iff C1&C2 == 0
1692struct AddMaskingAnd {
1693 Constant *C2;
1694 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1695 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001696 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001697 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001698 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001699 }
1700 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001701 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001702 }
1703};
1704
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001705static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001706 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001707 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001708 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001709 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001710
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001711 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::create(
1712 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001713 }
1714
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001715 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001716 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1717 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001718
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001719 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1720 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001721 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1722 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001723 }
1724
1725 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1726 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1727 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1728 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001729 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1730 New = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001731 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1732 New = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1733 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d96652004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001734 else {
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001735 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattnerf9d96652004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001736 abort();
1737 }
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001738 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1739}
1740
1741// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1742// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1743// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1744// not have a second operand.
1745static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1746 InstCombiner *IC) {
1747 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1748 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1749 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1750 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1751
1752 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner374e6592005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001753 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001754 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner374e6592005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001755
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001756 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1757 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1758
1759 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1760 SelectFalseVal);
1761 }
1762 return 0;
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001763}
1764
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001765
1766/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1767/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1768/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1769Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1770 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001771 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001772 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001773
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001774 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1775 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerc4d8e7e2007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001776 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001777 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1778 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1779 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1780 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerc4d8e7e2007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001781 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001782 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1783
1784 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1785 // loop.
1786 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1787 return 0;
1788 }
1789
1790 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1791 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1792 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1793 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1794 if (NonConstBB) {
1795 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1796 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1797 }
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001798
1799 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001800 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattnerd8e20182005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001801 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001802 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001803 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001804
1805 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1806 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1807 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001808 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001809 Value *InV;
1810 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001811 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1812 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1813 else
1814 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001815 } else {
1816 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1817 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1818 InV = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(),
1819 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1820 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001821 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1822 InV = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(),
1823 CI->getPredicate(),
1824 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1825 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001826 else
1827 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1828
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001829 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001830 }
1831 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001832 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001833 } else {
1834 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1835 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001836 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001837 Value *InV;
1838 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001839 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001840 } else {
1841 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001842 InV = CastInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
1843 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1844 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001845 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001846 }
1847 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001848 }
1849 }
1850 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1851}
1852
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001853Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001854 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001855 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001856
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001857 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001858 // X + undef -> undef
1859 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1860 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1861
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001862 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001863 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner7fde91e2005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001864 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattnerda1b1522005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001866 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
1867 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(-0.0))
1868 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner7fde91e2005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001869 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001870
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001871 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattner6e2c15c2006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001872 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001873 APInt Val(CI->getValue());
1874 unsigned BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
1875 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001876 return BinaryOperator::createXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner6e2c15c2006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001877
1878 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1879 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001880 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1881 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1882 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1883 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1884 return &I;
1885 }
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001886 }
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001887
1888 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1889 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1890 return NV;
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001891
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001892 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1893 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattner4284f642007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001894 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1895 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001896 unsigned TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001897 APInt RHSVal(cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue());
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001898
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001899 unsigned Size = TySizeBits / 2;
1900 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
1901 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001902 do {
1903 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001904 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1905 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001906 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
1907 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001908 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00001909 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
1910 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001911 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001912 break;
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001913 }
1914 }
1915 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001916 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
1917 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
1918 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001919
Reid Spencera5c18bf2007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001920 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
1921 // with funny bit widths then this whole cascade of if statements should
1922 // be removed. It is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back
1923 // up to something that the back ends can handle.
1924 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
1925 switch (Size) {
1926 default: break;
1927 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
1928 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
1929 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
1930 }
1931 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00001932 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001933 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencera5c18bf2007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001934 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001935 }
1936 }
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001937 }
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001938
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001939 // X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00001940 if (I.getType()->isInteger() && I.getType() != Type::Int1Ty) {
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001941 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +00001942
1943 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
1944 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
1945 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
1946 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
1947 }
1948 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
1949 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
1950 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
1951 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
1952 }
Robert Bocchino7b5b86c2004-07-27 21:02:21 +00001953 }
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00001954
Chris Lattner147e9752002-05-08 22:46:53 +00001955 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00001956 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(LHS))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001957 return BinaryOperator::createSub(RHS, V);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001958
1959 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00001960 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
1961 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001962 return BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00001963
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001964
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00001965 ConstantInt *C2;
1966 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
1967 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
1968 return BinaryOperator::createMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
1969
1970 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
1971 ConstantInt *C1;
1972 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00001973 return BinaryOperator::createMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00001974 }
1975
1976 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00001977 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
1978 return BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
1979
Chris Lattner23eb8ec2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00001980 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
1981 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS ||
1982 dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
1983 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
1984
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00001985
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001986 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001987 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattner23eb8ec2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00001988 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
1989 return R;
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +00001990
Chris Lattnerb9cde762003-10-02 15:11:26 +00001991 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001992 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00001993 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
1994 return BinaryOperator::createSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001995
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00001996 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
1997 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00001998 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00001999 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2000 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2001 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002002 APInt AddRHSV(CRHS->getValue());
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002003
2004 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002005 APInt AddRHSHighBits = ~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1);
2006 AddRHSHighBits &= C2->getType()->getMask();
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002007
2008 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002009 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd = AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002010
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002011 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2012 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
2013 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, CRHS,
2014 LHS->getName()), I);
2015 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewAdd, C2);
2016 }
2017 }
2018 }
2019
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002020 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2021 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002022 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002023 return R;
Chris Lattnerb9cde762003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002024 }
2025
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002026 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
2027 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) ->
2028 // intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth4f339be2006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002029 {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002030 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2031 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth4f339be2006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002032 if (!CI) {
2033 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2034 Other = LHS;
2035 }
Andrew Lenharth44cb67a2006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002036 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencer8f166b02007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002037 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2038 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth44cb67a2006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002039 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002040 Value *I2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002041 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty), I);
Andrew Lenharth44cb67a2006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002042 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new GetElementPtrInst(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002043 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth4f339be2006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002044 }
2045 }
2046
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002047 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002048}
2049
Chris Lattnerbdb0ce02003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002050// isSignBit - Return true if the value represented by the constant only has the
2051// highest order bit set.
2052static bool isSignBit(ConstantInt *CI) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002053 unsigned NumBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer450434e2007-03-19 20:58:18 +00002054 return CI->getValue() == APInt::getSignBit(NumBits);
Chris Lattnerbdb0ce02003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002055}
2056
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002057Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002058 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002059
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002060 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
2061 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002062
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002063 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002064 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002065 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002066
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002067 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2068 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2069 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2070 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2071
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002072 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2073 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002074 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
2075 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1);
Chris Lattnerad3c4952002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002076
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002077 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002078 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002079 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002080 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, AddOne(C));
2081
Chris Lattner27df1db2007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002082 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2083 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002084 if (C->isZero()) {
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002085 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002086 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002087 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002088 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002089 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002090 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002091 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002092 return BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr,
2093 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002094 }
2095 }
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002096 }
2097 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2098 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2099 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002100 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002101 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002102 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002103 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002104 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002105 }
2106 }
2107 }
Chris Lattner022167f2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002108 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002109
2110 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2111 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002112 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002113 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002114
2115 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2116 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2117 return NV;
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002118 }
2119
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002120 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2121 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002122 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002123 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002124 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002125 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002126 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002127 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2128 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2129 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002130 return BinaryOperator::createSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002131 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2132 }
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002133 }
2134
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002135 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002136 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2137 // is not used by anyone else...
2138 //
Chris Lattnerc2f0aa52004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002139 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002140 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002141 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2142 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2143 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2144 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002145
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002146 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002147 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002148 }
2149
2150 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2151 //
2152 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2153 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2154 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2155
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002156 Value *NewNot =
2157 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002158 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002159 }
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002160
Reid Spencer3c514952006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002161 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002162 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002163 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002164 if (CSI->isNullValue())
Chris Lattner0aee4b72004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002165 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002166 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner0aee4b72004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002167 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2168
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002169 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002170 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002171 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002172 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002173 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002174 }
Chris Lattnerad3c4952002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002175 }
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002176 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002177
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002178 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002179 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2180 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002181 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2182 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2183 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2184 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002185 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2186 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
2187 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002188 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002189
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002190 ConstantInt *C1;
2191 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002192 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
2193 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002194
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002195 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2196 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002197 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002198 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002199 return 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002200}
2201
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002202/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if it
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002203/// really just returns true if the most significant (sign) bit is set.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002204static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS) {
2205 switch (pred) {
2206 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
2207 // True if LHS s< RHS and RHS == 0
2208 return RHS->isNullValue();
2209 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
2210 // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2211 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
2212 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2213 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002214 return RHS->getValue() ==
2215 APInt::getSignBit(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002216 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2217 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002218 return RHS->getValue() ==
2219 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002220 default:
2221 return false;
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002222 }
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002223}
2224
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002225Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002226 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002227 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002228
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002229 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2230 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2231
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002232 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002233 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2234 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002235
2236 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002237 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002238 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2239 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002240 return BinaryOperator::createMul(SI->getOperand(0),
2241 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002242
Chris Lattnercce81be2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002243 if (CI->isNullValue())
2244 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2245 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2246 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2247 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Chris Lattner35236d82003-06-25 17:09:20 +00002248 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner31ba1292002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002249
Zhou Sheng4961cf12007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002250 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002251 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002252 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0,
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002253 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattner22d00a82005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002254 }
Robert Bocchino7b5b86c2004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002255 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002256 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2257 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner31ba1292002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002258
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002259 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2260 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
2261 if (Op1F->getValue() == 1.0)
2262 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2263 }
Chris Lattner32c01df2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002264
2265 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2266 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
2267 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
2268 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
2269 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
2270 Op1, "tmp");
2271 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2272 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2273 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
2274 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Add, C1C2);
2275
2276 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002277
2278 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2279 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002280 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002281 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002282
2283 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2284 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2285 return NV;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002286 }
2287
Chris Lattner934a64cf2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002288 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2289 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002290 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattner934a64cf2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002291
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002292 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2293 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2294 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2295 // formed.
2296 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002297 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002298 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002299 BoolCast = CI;
2300 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002301 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002302 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002303 BoolCast = CI;
2304 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002305 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002306 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2307 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
2308
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002309 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002310 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2311 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002312 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1))) {
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002313 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002314 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002315 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002316 Value *V =
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002317 InsertNewInstBefore(
2318 BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002319 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2320 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002321
2322 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2323 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002324 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
2325 unsigned SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2326 unsigned DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2327 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2328 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2329 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2330 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2331 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002332
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002333 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002334 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002335 }
2336 }
2337 }
2338
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002339 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002340}
2341
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002342/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2343/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2344/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2345/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002346Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002347 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002348
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002349 // undef / X -> 0
2350 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002351 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002352
2353 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002354 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002355 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002356
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002357 // Handle cases involving: div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002358 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2359 // div X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div X, Y. If the div and the select are in the
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002360 // same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the condition
2361 // of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same BB). If the
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002362 // select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be simplified
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002363 // also. Note that div X, Y is just as good as div X, 0 (undef)
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002364 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2365 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2366 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2367 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002368 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002369 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2370 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2371 else
2372 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
2373 return &I;
2374 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002375
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002376 // Likewise for: div X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div X, Y
2377 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2378 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2379 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2380 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002381 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002382 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2383 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2384 else
2385 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2386 return &I;
2387 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002388 }
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002389
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002390 return 0;
2391}
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002392
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002393/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2394/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2395/// division instructions.
2396/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002397Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002398 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2399
2400 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2401 return Common;
2402
2403 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2404 // div X, 1 == X
2405 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2406 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2407
2408 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2409 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2410 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2411 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
2412 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002413 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattner42362612005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002414 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002415
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002416 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002417 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2418 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2419 return R;
2420 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2421 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2422 return NV;
2423 }
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002424 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002425
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002426 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002427 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002428 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2429 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2430
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002431 return 0;
2432}
2433
2434Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2435 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2436
2437 // Handle the integer div common cases
2438 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2439 return Common;
2440
2441 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2442 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2443 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2444 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer54d5b1b2007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002445 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002446 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng222d5eb2007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002447 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002448 }
2449
2450 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002451 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002452 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2453 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002454 APInt C1(cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue());
2455 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002456 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002457 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002458 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002459 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
2460 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002461 }
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002462 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002463 }
2464 }
Chris Lattnerdd0c1742005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002465 }
2466
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002467 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2468 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002469 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002470 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002471 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002472 APInt TVA(STO->getValue()), FVA(SFO->getValue());
2473 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002474 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002475 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002476 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2477 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
2478 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2479 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2480 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2481
2482 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2483 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
2484 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2485 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2486 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002487
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002488 // construct the select instruction and return it.
2489 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002490 }
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002491 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002492 return 0;
2493}
2494
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002495Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2496 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2497
2498 // Handle the integer div common cases
2499 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2500 return Common;
2501
2502 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2503 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2504 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
2505 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0);
2506
2507 // -X/C -> X/-C
2508 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
2509 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
2510 }
2511
2512 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2513 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002514 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002515 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002516 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2517 return BinaryOperator::createUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2518 }
2519 }
2520
2521 return 0;
2522}
2523
2524Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2525 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2526}
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002527
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002528/// GetFactor - If we can prove that the specified value is at least a multiple
2529/// of some factor, return that factor.
2530static Constant *GetFactor(Value *V) {
2531 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
2532 return CI;
2533
2534 // Unless we can be tricky, we know this is a multiple of 1.
2535 Constant *Result = ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 1);
2536
2537 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
2538 if (!I) return Result;
2539
2540 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
2541 // Handle multiplies by a constant, etc.
2542 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)),
2543 GetFactor(I->getOperand(1)));
2544 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
2545 // (X<<C) -> X * (1 << C)
2546 if (Constant *ShRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2547 ShRHS = ConstantExpr::getShl(Result, ShRHS);
2548 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)), ShRHS);
2549 }
2550 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
2551 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2552 // X & 0xFFF0 is known to be a multiple of 16.
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002553 uint32_t Zeros = RHS->getValue().countTrailingZeros();
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002554 if (Zeros != V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
2555 return ConstantExpr::getShl(Result,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002556 ConstantInt::get(Result->getType(), Zeros));
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002557 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002558 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002559 // Only handle int->int casts.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002560 if (!CI->isIntegerCast())
2561 return Result;
2562 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
2563 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), GetFactor(Op), V->getType());
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002564 }
2565 return Result;
2566}
2567
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002568/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2569/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2570/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2571/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2572Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002573 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002574
Chris Lattner0de4a8d2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002575 // 0 % X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
2576 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2577 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2578 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2579
2580 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) // undef % X -> 0
2581 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2582 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2583 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002584
2585 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2586 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2587 // rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> rem X, Y. If the rem and the select are in
2588 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2589 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same
2590 // BB). If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2591 // simplified also.
2592 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2593 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2594 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2595 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002596 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002597 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2598 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2599 else
2600 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner7fd5f072004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002601 return &I;
2602 }
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002603 // Likewise for: rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> rem X, Y
2604 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2605 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2606 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2607 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002608 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002609 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2610 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2611 else
2612 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2613 return &I;
2614 }
Chris Lattnere9ff0ea2005-11-05 07:28:37 +00002615 }
Chris Lattner7fd5f072004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002616
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002617 return 0;
2618}
2619
2620/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2621/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2622/// remainder instructions.
2623/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2624Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2625 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2626
2627 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2628 return common;
2629
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002630 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner0de4a8d2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002631 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2632 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2633 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2634
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002635 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2636 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2637
Chris Lattnerb70f1412006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002638 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2639 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2640 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2641 return R;
2642 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2643 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2644 return NV;
Chris Lattnerb70f1412006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002645 }
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002646 // (X * C1) % C2 --> 0 iff C1 % C2 == 0
2647 if (ConstantExpr::getSRem(GetFactor(Op0I), RHS)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002648 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerb70f1412006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002649 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002650 }
2651
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002652 return 0;
2653}
2654
2655Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2656 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2657
2658 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2659 return common;
2660
2661 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2662 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2663 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2664 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2665 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002666 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002667 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
2668 }
2669
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002670 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002671 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2672 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2673 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng222d5eb2007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002674 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002675 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
2676 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(RHSI, N1,
2677 "tmp"), I);
2678 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, Add);
2679 }
2680 }
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002681 }
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002682
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002683 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2684 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2685 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2686 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2687 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2688 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002689 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2690 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002691 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2692 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
2693 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2694 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
2695 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
2696 }
2697 }
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002698 }
2699
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002700 return 0;
2701}
2702
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002703Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2704 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2705
2706 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2707 return common;
2708
2709 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
2710 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) ||
Zhou Sheng222d5eb2007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002711 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002712 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2713 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2714 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2715 return &I;
2716 }
2717
2718 // If the top bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2719 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002720 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002721 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2722 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
2723 return BinaryOperator::createURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2724 }
2725
2726 return 0;
2727}
2728
2729Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002730 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2731}
2732
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002733// isMaxValueMinusOne - return true if this is Max-1
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002734static bool isMaxValueMinusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Reid Spenceref599b02007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002735 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002736 if (isSigned) {
2737 // Calculate 0111111111..11111
Reid Spenceref599b02007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002738 APInt Val(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(TypeBits));
2739 return C->getValue() == Val-1;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002740 }
Reid Spenceref599b02007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002741 return C->getValue() == APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits) - 1;
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002742}
2743
2744// isMinValuePlusOne - return true if this is Min+1
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002745static bool isMinValuePlusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
2746 if (isSigned) {
2747 // Calculate 1111111111000000000000
Reid Spencer3b93db72007-03-19 21:08:07 +00002748 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2749 APInt Val(APInt::getSignedMinValue(TypeBits));
2750 return C->getValue() == Val+1;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002751 }
Reid Spencer3b93db72007-03-19 21:08:07 +00002752 return C->getValue() == 1; // unsigned
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002753}
2754
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002755// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2756// constant.
2757static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer66827212007-03-20 00:16:52 +00002758 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002759}
2760
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002761// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2762// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2763static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Shengb3949342007-03-20 12:49:06 +00002764 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002765}
2766
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002767/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002768/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
2769///
2770/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
2771///
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002772/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
2773/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002774///
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002775/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
2776/// 0 A > B
2777/// 1 A == B
2778/// 2 A < B
2779///
2780/// <=> Value Definition
2781/// 000 0 Always false
2782/// 001 1 A > B
2783/// 010 2 A == B
2784/// 011 3 A >= B
2785/// 100 4 A < B
2786/// 101 5 A != B
2787/// 110 6 A <= B
2788/// 111 7 Always true
2789///
2790static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
2791 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002792 // False -> 0
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002793 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
2794 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
2795 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
2796 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
2797 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
2798 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
2799 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
2800 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
2801 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
2802 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002803 // True -> 7
2804 default:
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002805 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002806 return 0;
2807 }
2808}
2809
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002810/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
2811/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
2812/// new /// ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
2813/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
2814static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2815 switch (code) {
2816 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002817 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002818 case 1:
2819 if (sign)
2820 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
2821 else
2822 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
2823 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
2824 case 3:
2825 if (sign)
2826 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
2827 else
2828 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
2829 case 4:
2830 if (sign)
2831 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
2832 else
2833 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
2834 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
2835 case 6:
2836 if (sign)
2837 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
2838 else
2839 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002840 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002841 }
2842}
2843
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002844static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
2845 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
2846 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
2847 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
2848 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
2849 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
2850}
2851
2852namespace {
2853// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
2854struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002855 InstCombiner &IC;
2856 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002857 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
2858 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
2859 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
2860 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002861 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002862 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
2863 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
2864 return (ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS ||
2865 ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002866 return false;
2867 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002868 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
2869 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
2870 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
2871 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
2872 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002873 }
2874
Chris Lattnerd1bce952007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002875 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002876 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerd1bce952007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002877 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002878 unsigned Code;
2879 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
2880 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
2881 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
2882 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner2caaaba2003-09-22 20:33:34 +00002883 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002884 }
2885
Chris Lattnerd1bce952007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002886 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
2887 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
2888
2889 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002890 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
2891 return I;
2892 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
2893 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
2894 }
2895};
Chris Lattnere3a63d12006-11-15 04:53:24 +00002896} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002897
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002898// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
2899// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002900// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002901Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002902 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
2903 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002904 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
2905 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerfcf21a72004-01-12 19:47:05 +00002906 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002907 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002908 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002909
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002910 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
2911 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002912 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002913 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002914 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002915 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002916 And->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002917 return BinaryOperator::createXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002918 }
2919 break;
2920 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002921 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
2922 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002923
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002924 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
2925 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002926 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002927 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002928 Or->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002929 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002930 }
2931 break;
2932 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002933 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002934 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
2935 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
2936 // single bit constant.
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00002937 APInt AndRHSV(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue());
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002938
2939 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002940 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002941 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
2942 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
2943 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00002944 APInt AddRHS(cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue());
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002945
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002946 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
2947 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
2948 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
2949 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
2950 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
2951 // no effect.
2952 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
2953 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
2954 return &TheAnd;
2955 } else {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002956 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002957 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002958 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002959 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002960 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002961 }
2962 }
2963 }
2964 }
2965 break;
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00002966
2967 case Instruction::Shl: {
2968 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
2969 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
2970 //
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002971 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00002972 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002973 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
2974 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002975
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002976 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
2977 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00002978 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
2979 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00002980 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
2981 return &TheAnd;
2982 }
2983 break;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002984 }
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002985 case Instruction::LShr:
2986 {
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00002987 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
2988 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
2989 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
2990 //
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002991 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00002992 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002993 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
2994 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00002995
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002996 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
2997 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002998 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
2999 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3000 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3001 return &TheAnd;
3002 }
3003 break;
3004 }
3005 case Instruction::AShr:
3006 // Signed shr.
3007 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3008 // with an and.
3009 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003010 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003011 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003012 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3013 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003014 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003015 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003016 // Make the argument unsigned.
3017 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003018 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00003019 BinaryOperator::createLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003020 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003021 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003022 }
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003023 }
3024 break;
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003025 }
3026 return 0;
3027}
3028
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003029
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003030/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3031/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003032/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3033/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003034/// insert new instructions.
3035Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003036 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3037 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003038 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003039 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003040 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003041
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003042 if (Inside) {
3043 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003044 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003045
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003046 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003047 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003048 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003049 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3050 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3051 }
3052
3053 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3054 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
3055 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003056 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003057 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3058 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003059 }
3060
3061 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003062 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003063
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003064 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003065 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003066 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003067 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3068 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3069 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3070 }
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003071
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003072 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3073 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3074 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003075 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003076 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003077 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3078 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003079}
3080
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003081// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3082// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3083// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3084// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003085static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, unsigned &MB, unsigned &ME) {
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003086 APInt V = Val->getValue();
3087 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3088 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003089
3090 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003091 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003092 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003093 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003094 return true;
3095}
3096
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003097/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3098/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3099/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003100///
3101/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3102/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3103/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3104///
3105/// return (A +/- B).
3106///
3107Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003108 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003109 Instruction &I) {
3110 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3111 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3112 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3113
3114 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3115
3116 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3117 default: return 0;
3118 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003119 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003120 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Shenge9ebd3f2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003121 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3122 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3123 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003124 break;
3125
3126 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3127 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3128 // is all N is, ignore it.
Reid Spencer755d0e72007-03-26 17:44:01 +00003129 unsigned MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003130 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003131 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003132 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003133 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003134 break;
3135 }
3136 }
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003137 return 0;
3138 case Instruction::Or:
3139 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003140 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Shenge9ebd3f2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003141 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3142 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer54d5b1b2007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003143 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003144 break;
3145 return 0;
3146 }
3147
3148 Instruction *New;
3149 if (isSub)
3150 New = BinaryOperator::createSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3151 else
3152 New = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3153 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3154}
3155
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003156Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003157 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003158 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003159
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003160 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3161 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3162
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003163 // and X, X = X
3164 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003165 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003166
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003167 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003168 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003169 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003170 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3171 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3172 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner120ab032007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003173 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer54d5b1b2007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003174 return &I;
Chris Lattner120ab032007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003175 } else {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003176 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner120ab032007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003177 if (CP->isAllOnesValue())
3178 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
3179 }
3180 }
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003181
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003182 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003183 APInt AndRHSMask(AndRHS->getValue());
3184 APInt TypeMask(cast<IntegerType>(Op0->getType())->getMask());
3185 APInt NotAndRHS = AndRHSMask^TypeMask;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003186
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003187 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003188 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003189 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003190 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3191 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3192 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3193 case Instruction::Xor:
3194 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003195 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3196 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3197 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3198 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
3199 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
3200 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3201 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
3202 return BinaryOperator::create(
3203 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003204 }
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003205 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003206 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3207 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
3208 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
3209 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3210 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
3211 return BinaryOperator::create(
3212 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3213 }
3214 }
3215
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003216 break;
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003217 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003218 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3219 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3220 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3221 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3222 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
3223 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3224 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003225 break;
3226
3227 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003228 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3229 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3230 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3231 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
3232 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003233 break;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003234 }
3235
Chris Lattner16464b32003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003236 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003237 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003238 return Res;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003239 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003240 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3241 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3242 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3243 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003244 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003245 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattnerab2dc4d2006-02-08 07:34:50 +00003246 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003247 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3248 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003249 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3250 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3251 // other simplifications.
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003252 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::createTruncOrBitCast(
3253 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3254 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003255 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003256 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003257 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003258 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003259 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewCast, C3);
3260 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3261 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3262 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattner2dc148e2006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003263 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003264 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3265 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3266 }
3267 }
Chris Lattner33217db2003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003268 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003269
3270 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3271 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003272 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003273 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003274 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3275 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3276 return NV;
Chris Lattner49b47ae2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003277 }
3278
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003279 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3280 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003281
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003282 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3283 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3284
Misha Brukman9c003d82004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003285 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003286 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003287 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
3288 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattner49b47ae2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003289 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003290 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Or);
3291 }
Chris Lattner8b10ab32006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003292
3293 {
3294 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
Chris Lattner8b10ab32006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003295 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3296 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3297 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3298 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3299 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3300 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003301
3302 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3303 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3304 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3305 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3306 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3307 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3308 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3309 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3310 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3311 }
3312 }
3313 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3314 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3315 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3316 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3317 std::swap(A, B);
3318 }
3319 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
3320 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::createNot(B, "tmp");
3321 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
3322 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
3323 }
3324 }
Chris Lattner8b10ab32006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003325 }
3326
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003327 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3328 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3329 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003330 return R;
3331
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003332 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3333 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003334 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3335 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3336 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3337 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3338 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3339 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3340 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3341 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3342 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003343 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003344 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3345 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3346 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3347 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003348 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003349 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3350 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3351 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3352 }
3353
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003354 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003355 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3356 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003357 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3358 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3359 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003360 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3361
3362 switch (LHSCC) {
3363 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003364 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003365 switch (RHSCC) {
3366 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003367 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3368 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3369 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003370 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003371 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3372 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3373 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003374 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3375 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003376 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003377 switch (RHSCC) {
3378 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003379 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3380 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3381 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3382 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3383 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3384 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3385 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3386 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3387 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3388 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3389 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003390 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003391 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3392 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003393 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3394 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3395 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3396 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattnerc8fb6de2007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003397 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3398 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003399 }
3400 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3401 }
3402 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003403 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003404 switch (RHSCC) {
3405 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003406 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3407 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003408 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003409 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3410 break;
3411 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3412 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003413 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003414 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3415 break;
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003416 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003417 break;
3418 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003419 switch (RHSCC) {
3420 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003421 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3422 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003423 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003424 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3425 break;
3426 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3427 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003428 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003429 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3430 break;
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003431 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003432 break;
3433 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3434 switch (RHSCC) {
3435 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3436 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X > 13
3437 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3438 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3439 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3440 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3441 break;
3442 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3443 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3444 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3445 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3446 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3447 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3448 true, I);
3449 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3450 break;
3451 }
3452 break;
3453 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3454 switch (RHSCC) {
3455 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3456 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X s> 13
3457 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3458 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3459 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3460 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3461 break;
3462 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3463 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3464 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3465 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3466 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3467 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3468 true, I);
3469 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3470 break;
3471 }
3472 break;
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003473 }
3474 }
3475 }
3476
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003477 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003478 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3479 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3480 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3481 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003482 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003483 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003484 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3485 I.getType(), TD) &&
3486 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3487 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003488 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3489 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3490 I.getName());
3491 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3492 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3493 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003494 }
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003495
3496 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003497 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3498 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3499 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003500 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3501 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3502 Instruction *NewOp =
3503 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
3504 SI1->getOperand(0),
3505 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003506 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3507 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003508 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003509 }
3510
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003511 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003512}
3513
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003514/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3515/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3516/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner99c6cf62007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003517static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003518 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3519 if (I == 0) return true;
3520
3521 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3522 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3523 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3524 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3525
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003526 uint32_t BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003527 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3528 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003529 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003530 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003531 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) !=
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003532 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3533 return true;
3534
3535 unsigned DestNo;
3536 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3537 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3538 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3539 } else {
3540 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3541 DestNo = 0;
3542 }
3543
3544 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3545 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3546 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3547 return true;
3548 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3549 return false;
3550 }
3551
3552 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3553 // don't have this.
3554 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3555 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3556 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3557 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3558 return true;
3559 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3560
3561 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003562 if (ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) & 7 ||
3563 ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003564 return true;
3565
3566 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3567 unsigned DestByte;
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003568 if (AndAmt->getValue().getActiveBits() > 64)
3569 return true;
3570 uint64_t AndAmtVal = AndAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003571 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003572 if (AndAmtVal == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003573 break;
3574 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3575 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3576
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003577 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003578 unsigned SrcByte;
3579 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3580 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3581 else
3582 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3583
3584 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3585 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3586 return true;
3587
3588 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3589 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3590 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3591 return true;
3592 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3593 return false;
3594}
3595
3596/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3597/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3598Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003599 // We cannot bswap one byte.
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00003600 if (I.getType() == Type::Int8Ty)
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003601 return 0;
3602
3603 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3604 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner99c6cf62007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003605 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00003606 ByteValues.resize(TD->getTypeSize(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003607
3608 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3609 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3610 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3611 return 0;
3612
3613 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3614 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3615 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3616
3617 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3618 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3619 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3620 return 0;
3621
3622 // If they do then *success* we can turn this into a bswap. Figure out what
3623 // bswap to make it into.
3624 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner091b6ea2006-07-11 18:31:26 +00003625 const char *FnName = 0;
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00003626 if (I.getType() == Type::Int16Ty)
Reid Spencer6bba6c82007-04-01 07:35:23 +00003627 FnName = "llvm.bswap.i16.i16";
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00003628 else if (I.getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
Reid Spencer6bba6c82007-04-01 07:35:23 +00003629 FnName = "llvm.bswap.i32.i32";
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00003630 else if (I.getType() == Type::Int64Ty)
Reid Spencer6bba6c82007-04-01 07:35:23 +00003631 FnName = "llvm.bswap.i64.i64";
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003632 else
3633 assert(0 && "Unknown integer type!");
Chris Lattnerfbc524f2007-01-07 06:58:05 +00003634 Constant *F = M->getOrInsertFunction(FnName, I.getType(), I.getType(), NULL);
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003635 return new CallInst(F, V);
3636}
3637
3638
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003639Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003640 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003641 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003642
Chris Lattner3a8248f2007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003643 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
3644 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003645
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003646 // or X, X = X
3647 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003648 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003649
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003650 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3651 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner3a8248f2007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003652 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3653 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3654 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3655 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3656 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3657 return &I;
3658 }
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003659
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003660 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003661 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003662 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003663 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3664 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003665 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003666 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003667 Or->takeName(Op0);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003668 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, ConstantExpr::getOr(RHS, C1));
3669 }
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003670
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003671 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3672 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003673 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003674 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003675 Or->takeName(Op0);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003676 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Or,
3677 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS)));
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003678 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003679
3680 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3681 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003682 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003683 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003684 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3685 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3686 return NV;
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003687 }
3688
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003689 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3690 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner4294cec2005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003691
3692 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3693 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
3694 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3695 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3696 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
3697 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3698
Chris Lattnerb7845d62006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003699 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
3700 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003701 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattnerb7845d62006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003702 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
3703 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
3704 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003705 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
3706 return BSwap;
3707 }
3708
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003709 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3710 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003711 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003712 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op1);
3713 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3714 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3715 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003716 }
3717
3718 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3719 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003720 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003721 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op0);
3722 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3723 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3724 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003725 }
3726
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003727 // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003728 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003729 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
3730
3731 if (A == B) // (A & C1)|(A & C2) == A & (C1|C2)
3732 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, ConstantExpr::getOr(C1, C2));
3733
3734
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003735 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
3736 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
3737 // replace with V+N.
3738 if (C1 == ConstantExpr::getNot(C2)) {
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003739 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0;
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003740 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003741 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3742 // Add commutes, try both ways.
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003743 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003744 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003745 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003746 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3747 }
3748 // Or commutes, try both ways.
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003749 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003750 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3751 // Add commutes, try both ways.
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003752 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003753 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003754 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003755 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003756 }
3757 }
3758 }
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003759
3760 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003761 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3762 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3763 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003764 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3765 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3766 Instruction *NewOp =
3767 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
3768 SI1->getOperand(0),
3769 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003770 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3771 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003772 }
3773 }
Chris Lattner812aab72003-08-12 19:11:07 +00003774
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003775 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
3776 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003777 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003778 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003779 } else {
3780 A = 0;
3781 }
Chris Lattner4294cec2005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003782 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003783 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
3784 if (Op0 == B)
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003785 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003786 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner3e327a42003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003787
Misha Brukman9c003d82004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003788 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003789 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3790 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, B,
3791 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
3792 return BinaryOperator::createNot(And);
3793 }
Chris Lattner3e327a42003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003794 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003795
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003796 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3797 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3798 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003799 return R;
3800
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003801 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3802 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003803 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3804 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3805 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3806 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
3807 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
3808 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3809 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3810 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3811 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003812 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003813 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3814 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3815 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3816 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003817 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003818 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3819 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3820 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3821 }
3822
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003823 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003824 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
3825 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003826 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
3827 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003828 // equal.
3829 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3830
3831 switch (LHSCC) {
3832 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003833 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003834 switch (RHSCC) {
3835 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003836 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003837 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
3838 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3839 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3840 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3841 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003842 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getSub(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003843 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003844 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003845 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
3846 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
3847 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner5c219462005-04-19 06:04:18 +00003848 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003849 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3850 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
3851 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003852 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3853 }
3854 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003855 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003856 switch (RHSCC) {
3857 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003858 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
3859 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
3860 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003861 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003862 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
3863 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
3864 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003866 }
3867 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003868 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003869 switch (RHSCC) {
3870 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003871 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003872 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003873 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
3874 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
3875 false, I);
3876 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
3877 break;
3878 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3879 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003880 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003881 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
3882 break;
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003883 }
3884 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003885 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003886 switch (RHSCC) {
3887 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003888 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
3889 break;
3890 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
3891 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
3892 false, I);
3893 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
3894 break;
3895 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3896 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
3897 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3898 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
3899 break;
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003900 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003901 break;
3902 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3903 switch (RHSCC) {
3904 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3905 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
3906 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
3907 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3908 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
3909 break;
3910 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
3911 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003912 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003913 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
3914 break;
3915 }
3916 break;
3917 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3918 switch (RHSCC) {
3919 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3920 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
3921 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
3922 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3923 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
3924 break;
3925 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
3926 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003927 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003928 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
3929 break;
3930 }
3931 break;
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003932 }
3933 }
3934 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003935
3936 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003937 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003938 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003939 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
3940 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003941 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003942 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003943 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3944 I.getType(), TD) &&
3945 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3946 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003947 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3948 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3949 I.getName());
3950 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3951 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3952 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003953 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003954
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003955
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003956 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003957}
3958
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00003959// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
3960struct XorSelf {
3961 Value *RHS;
3962 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
3963 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
3964 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
3965 return &Xor;
3966 }
3967};
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003968
3969
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003970Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003971 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003972 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003973
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003974 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
3975 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
3976
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00003977 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
3978 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
3979 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?");
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003980 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00003981 }
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003982
3983 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3984 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003985 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3986 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3987 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3988 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3989 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3990 return &I;
3991 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003992
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003993 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003994 // xor (icmp A, B), true = not (icmp A, B) = !icmp A, B
3995 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003996 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && ICI->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003997 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
3998 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere5806662003-11-04 23:50:51 +00003999
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004000 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004001 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004002 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4003 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004004 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4005 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004006 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004007 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004008 }
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004009
4010 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y)
4011 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
4012 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4013 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4014 Instruction *NotY =
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004015 BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004016 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4017 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4018 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4019 }
4020 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004021
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004022 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004023 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner0f68fa62003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004024 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004025 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004026 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
4027 return BinaryOperator::createSub(
4028 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004029 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner0f68fa62003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004030 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004031 }
Chris Lattnerf78df7c2006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004032 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4033 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004034 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattnerf78df7c2006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004035 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4036 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4037 // NewRHS.
4038 Constant *CommonBits = ConstantExpr::getAnd(Op0CI, RHS);
4039 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4040 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004041 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattnerf78df7c2006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004042 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4043 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4044 return &I;
4045 }
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004046 }
Chris Lattnerb8d6e402002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004047 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004048
4049 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4050 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004051 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004052 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004053 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4054 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4055 return NV;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004056 }
4057
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004058 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004059 if (X == Op1)
4060 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004061 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004062
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004063 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004064 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004065 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004066
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004067
4068 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4069 if (Op1I) {
4070 Value *A, *B;
4071 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4072 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004073 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004074 I.swapOperands();
4075 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004076 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004077 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004078 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004079 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004080 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4081 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4082 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4083 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4084 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4085 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner04277992007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004086 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004087 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner04277992007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004088 std::swap(A, B);
4089 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004090 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004091 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4092 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4093 }
Chris Lattnerb36d9082004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004094 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004095 }
4096
4097 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4098 if (Op0I) {
4099 Value *A, *B;
4100 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4101 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4102 std::swap(A, B);
4103 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4104 Instruction *NotB =
4105 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4106 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004107 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004108 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4109 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4110 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4111 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4112 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4113 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4114 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4115 std::swap(A, B);
4116 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattner6cf49142006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004117 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004118 Instruction *N =
4119 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(A, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004120 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(N, Op1);
4121 }
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004122 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004123 }
4124
4125 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4126 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4127 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4128 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4129 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4130 Instruction *NewOp =
4131 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
4132 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4133 Op0I->getName()), I);
4134 return BinaryOperator::create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
4135 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4136 }
4137
4138 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4139 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4140 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4141 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4142 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4143 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4144 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4145 }
4146 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4147 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4148 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4149 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4150 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4151 }
4152
4153 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4154 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4155 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4156 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4157 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4158 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4159 if (A == C)
4160 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4161 else if (A == D)
4162 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4163 else if (B == C)
4164 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4165 else if (B == D)
4166 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4167
4168 if (X) {
4169 Instruction *NewOp =
4170 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4171 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewOp, X);
4172 }
4173 }
4174 }
4175
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004176 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4177 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4178 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004179 return R;
4180
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004181 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004182 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004183 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004184 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4185 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004186 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004187 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004188 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4189 I.getType(), TD) &&
4190 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4191 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004192 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4193 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4194 I.getName());
4195 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4196 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4197 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004198 }
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004199
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004200 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004201}
4202
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004203/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4204/// overflowed for this type.
4205static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004206 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004207 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getAdd(In1, In2));
4208
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004209 if (IsSigned)
4210 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4211 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4212 else
4213 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4214 else
4215 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004216}
4217
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004218/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4219/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4220/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4221static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4222 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4223 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004224 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4225 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004226
4227 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner77defba2006-02-07 07:00:41 +00004228 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-TD.getPointerSize()*8);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004229
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004230 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4231 Value *Op = GEP->getOperand(i);
Chris Lattnerd35d2102005-01-13 23:26:48 +00004232 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004233 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004234 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
4235 if (!OpC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004236 OpC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004237 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4238 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4239 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4240 else {
4241 // Emit an add instruction.
4242 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4243 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result, Scale,
4244 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4245 }
4246 }
4247 } else {
Chris Lattner7aa41cf2005-01-14 17:17:59 +00004248 // Convert to correct type.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004249 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::createSExtOrBitCast(Op, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner7aa41cf2005-01-14 17:17:59 +00004250 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4251 if (Size != 1)
Chris Lattner4cb9fa32005-01-13 20:40:58 +00004252 // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
4253 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(Op, Scale,
4254 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004255
4256 // Emit an add instruction.
Chris Lattner4cb9fa32005-01-13 20:40:58 +00004257 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004258 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4259 }
4260 }
4261 return Result;
4262}
4263
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004264/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004265/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004266Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4267 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4268 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004269 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004270
4271 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS))
4272 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
4273 RHS = CI->getOperand(0);
4274
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004275 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4276 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
4277 // As an optimization, we don't actually have to compute the actual value of
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004278 // OFFSET if this is a icmp_eq or icmp_ne comparison, just return whether
4279 // each index is zero or not.
4280 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) {
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004281 Instruction *InVal = 0;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004282 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEPLHS);
4283 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004284 bool EmitIt = true;
4285 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))) {
4286 if (isa<UndefValue>(C)) // undef index -> undef.
4287 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
4288 if (C->isNullValue())
4289 EmitIt = false;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004290 else if (TD->getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) == 0) {
4291 EmitIt = false; // This is indexing into a zero sized array?
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004292 } else if (isa<ConstantInt>(C))
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004293 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004294 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4295 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004296 }
4297
4298 if (EmitIt) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004299 Instruction *Comp =
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004300 new ICmpInst(Cond, GEPLHS->getOperand(i),
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004301 Constant::getNullValue(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()));
4302 if (InVal == 0)
4303 InVal = Comp;
4304 else {
4305 InVal = InsertNewInstBefore(InVal, I);
4306 InsertNewInstBefore(Comp, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004307 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) // True if any are unequal
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004308 InVal = BinaryOperator::createOr(InVal, Comp);
4309 else // True if all are equal
4310 InVal = BinaryOperator::createAnd(InVal, Comp);
4311 }
4312 }
4313 }
4314
4315 if (InVal)
4316 return InVal;
4317 else
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004318 // No comparison is needed here, all indexes = 0
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004319 ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4320 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004321 }
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004322
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004323 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004324 // the result to fold to a constant!
4325 if (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) {
4326 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
4327 Value *Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004328 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4329 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004330 }
4331 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004332 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4333 // compare the base pointer.
4334 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4335 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004336 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattnerbd43b9d2005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004337 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004338 if (IndicesTheSame)
4339 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4340 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4341 IndicesTheSame = false;
4342 break;
4343 }
4344
4345 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4346 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004347 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4348 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004349
4350 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4351 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004352 return 0;
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004353 }
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004354
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004355 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4356 bool AllZeros = true;
4357 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4358 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4359 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4360 AllZeros = false;
4361 break;
4362 }
4363 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004364 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4365 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004366
4367 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004368 AllZeros = true;
4369 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4370 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4371 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4372 AllZeros = false;
4373 break;
4374 }
4375 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004376 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004377
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004378 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4379 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4380 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4381 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4382 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4383 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004384 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4385 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnerfc4429e2005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004386 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004387 NumDifferences = 2;
4388 break;
4389 } else {
4390 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4391 DiffOperand = i;
4392 }
4393 }
4394
4395 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4396 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004397 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4398 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004399 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattnerfc4429e2005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004400 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4401 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004402 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4403 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004404 }
4405 }
4406
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004407 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004408 // the result to fold to a constant!
4409 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4410 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4411 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4412 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4413 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004414 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004415 }
4416 }
4417 return 0;
4418}
4419
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004420Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
4421 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004422 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004423
Chris Lattner6ee923f2007-01-14 19:42:17 +00004424 // Fold trivial predicates.
4425 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4426 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
4427 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4428 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4429
4430 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
4431 if (Op0 == Op1) {
4432 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4433 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
4434 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
4435 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
4436 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
4437 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4438 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
4439 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
4440 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
4441 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4442
4443 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
4444 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
4445 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
4446 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
4447 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
4448 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
4449 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4450 return &I;
4451
4452 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
4453 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
4454 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
4455 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
4456 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
4457 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
4458 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4459 return &I;
4460 }
4461 }
4462
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004463 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004464 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004465
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004466 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
4467 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4468 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4469 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4470 case Instruction::PHI:
4471 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4472 return NV;
4473 break;
4474 case Instruction::Select:
4475 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4476 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4477 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4478 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4479 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4480 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4481 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4482 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4483 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4484 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4485 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4486 I.getName()), I);
4487 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4488 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4489 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4490 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4491 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4492 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4493 I.getName()), I);
4494 }
4495 }
4496
4497 if (Op1)
4498 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4499 break;
4500 }
4501 }
4502
4503 return Changed ? &I : 0;
4504}
4505
4506Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
4507 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
4508 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
4509 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
4510
4511 // icmp X, X
4512 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004513 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4514 isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004515
4516 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004517 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004518
4519 // icmp of GlobalValues can never equal each other as long as they aren't
4520 // external weak linkage type.
4521 if (GlobalValue *GV0 = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Op0))
4522 if (GlobalValue *GV1 = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Op1))
4523 if (!GV0->hasExternalWeakLinkage() || !GV1->hasExternalWeakLinkage())
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004524 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4525 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004526
4527 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner15ff1e12004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004528 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004529 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
4530 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
4531 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner15ff1e12004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004532 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004533 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4534 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004535
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004536 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004537 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004538 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4539 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
4540 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004541 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004542 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004543 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004544 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004545 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> A^B
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004546 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004547
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004548 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4549 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4550 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp gt -> icmp lt
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004551 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004552 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4553 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp lt bool A, B -> ~X & Y
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004554 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4555 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4556 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Not, Op1);
4557 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004558 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4559 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4560 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ge -> icmp le
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004561 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004562 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4563 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp le bool %A, %B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004564 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4565 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4566 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Not, Op1);
4567 }
4568 }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004569 }
4570
Chris Lattner2dd01742004-06-09 04:24:29 +00004571 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
4572 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004573 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004574 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4575 default: break;
4576 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // A <u MIN -> FALSE
4577 if (CI->isMinValue(false))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004578 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004579 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
4580 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,Op1);
4581 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4582 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4583 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004584
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004585 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4586 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <s MIN -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004587 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004588 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
4589 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4590 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4591 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4592 break;
4593
4594 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4595 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >u MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004596 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004597 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
4598 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4599 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, false)) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4600 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4601 break;
4602
4603 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4604 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >s MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004605 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004606 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
4607 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4608 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, true)) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4609 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4610 break;
4611
4612 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4613 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004614 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004615 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A <=u MIN -> A == MIN
4616 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4617 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,false)) // A <=u MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4618 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4619 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004620
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004621 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4622 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004623 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004624 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <=s MIN -> A == MIN
4625 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4626 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,true)) // A <=s MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4627 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4628 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004629
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004630 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4631 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004632 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004633 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >=u MAX -> A == MAX
4634 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4635 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A >=u MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4636 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4637 break;
4638
4639 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4640 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004641 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004642 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >=s MAX -> A == MAX
4643 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4644 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A >=s MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4645 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4646 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004647 }
4648
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004649 // If we still have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
4650 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. Since the border cases have
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004651 // already been handled above, this requires little checking.
4652 //
Reid Spencer624766f2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004653 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4654 default: break;
4655 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4656 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4657 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4658 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4659 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4660 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4661 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4662 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4663 }
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004664
4665 // See if we can fold the comparison based on bits known to be zero or one
4666 // in the input.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004667 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
4668 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4669 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004670 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
4671 return &I;
4672
4673 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
4674 // in.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004675 if ((KnownOne | KnownZero) != 0) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004676 // Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
4677 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004678 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0), RHSVal(CI->getValue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004679 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004680 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4681 Max);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004682 } else {
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004683 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4684 Max);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004685 }
4686 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
4687 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
4688 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004689 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004690 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004691 break;
4692 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004693 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004694 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004695 break;
4696 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004697 if (Max.ult(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004698 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004699 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004700 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004701 break;
4702 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004703 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004704 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004705 if (Max.ult(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004706 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004707 break;
4708 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004709 if (Max.slt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004710 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004711 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004712 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004713 break;
4714 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004715 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004716 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004717 if (Max.slt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004718 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004719 break;
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004720 }
4721 }
4722
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004723 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004724 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004725 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattnere1e10e12004-05-25 06:32:08 +00004726 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004727 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4728 case Instruction::And:
4729 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
4730 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004731 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
4732
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004733 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004734 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
4735 // produced, eliminating a cast.
4736 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
4737 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
4738 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
4739 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
4740 // bit would not work.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004741 if (Cast->hasOneUse() && isa<TruncInst>(Cast) &&
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004742 (I.isEquality() || AndCST->getValue().isPositive() &&
4743 CI->getValue().isPositive())) {
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004744 ConstantInt *NewCST;
4745 ConstantInt *NewCI;
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004746 APInt NewCSTVal(AndCST->getValue()), NewCIVal(CI->getValue());
4747 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(
4748 Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
4749 NewCST = ConstantInt::get(NewCSTVal.zext(BitWidth));
4750 NewCI = ConstantInt::get(NewCIVal.zext(BitWidth));
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004751 Instruction *NewAnd =
4752 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Cast->getOperand(0), NewCST,
4753 LHSI->getName());
4754 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004755 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), NewAnd, NewCI);
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004756 }
4757 }
4758
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004759 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
4760 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
4761 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
4762 // access.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004763 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
4764 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
4765 Shift = 0;
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004766
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004767 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
4768 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004769 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
4770 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004771
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004772 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
4773 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
4774 // rights, as they sign-extend.
4775 if (ShAmt) {
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004776 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004777 if (!CanFold) {
4778 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
4779 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00004780 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
4781 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
Chris Lattnerc53cb9d2005-06-17 01:29:28 +00004782
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00004783 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
4784 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
4785 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004786 CanFold = true;
4787 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004788
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004789 if (CanFold) {
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00004790 Constant *NewCst;
4791 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004792 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(CI, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00004793 else
4794 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt);
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00004795
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004796 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
4797 // compared.
4798 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != CI){
4799 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
4800 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
4801 // result is always true or false now.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004802 if (I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004803 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004804 if (I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004805 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004806 } else {
4807 I.setOperand(1, NewCst);
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00004808 Constant *NewAndCST;
4809 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004810 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00004811 else
4812 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
4813 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
Reid Spencer6ff3e732007-01-04 05:23:51 +00004814 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004815 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004816 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
4817 return &I;
Chris Lattner1638de42004-07-21 19:50:44 +00004818 }
4819 }
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00004820 }
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004821
4822 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
4823 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
4824 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
4825 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && CI->isNullValue() &&
Chris Lattnerde077922006-09-18 18:27:05 +00004826 I.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
4827 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004828 // Compute C << Y.
4829 Value *NS;
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004830 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00004831 NS = BinaryOperator::createShl(AndCST,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004832 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004833 } else {
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00004834 // Insert a logical shift.
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00004835 NS = BinaryOperator::createLShr(AndCST,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004836 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004837 }
4838 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), I);
4839
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004840 // Compute X & (C << Y).
Reid Spencer6ff3e732007-01-04 05:23:51 +00004841 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(
4842 Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004843 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, I);
4844
4845 I.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
4846 return &I;
4847 }
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004848 }
4849 break;
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00004850
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004851 case Instruction::Shl: // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004852 if (ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004853 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00004854 unsigned TypeBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
4855
4856 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
4857 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
4858 // simplified.
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00004859 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00004860 break;
4861
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004862 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
4863 // comparison cannot succeed.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004864 Constant *Comp =
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004865 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(CI, ShAmt), ShAmt);
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004866 if (Comp != CI) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004867 bool IsICMP_NE = I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004868 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004869 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Cst);
4870 }
4871
4872 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4873 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00004874 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00004875 uint64_t Val = (1ULL << (TypeBits-ShAmtVal))-1;
4876 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), Val);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004877
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004878 Instruction *AndI =
4879 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
4880 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
4881 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004882 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And,
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004883 ConstantExpr::getLShr(CI, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004884 }
4885 }
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004886 }
4887 break;
4888
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004889 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004890 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004891 if (ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004892 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00004893 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
4894 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
4895 // simplified.
Chris Lattner104002b2005-06-16 01:52:07 +00004896 unsigned TypeBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00004897 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00004898 break;
4899
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004900 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
4901 // comparison cannot succeed.
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004902 Constant *Comp;
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00004903 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004904 Comp = ConstantExpr::getLShr(ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt),
4905 ShAmt);
4906 else
4907 Comp = ConstantExpr::getAShr(ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt),
4908 ShAmt);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004909
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004910 if (Comp != CI) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004911 bool IsICMP_NE = I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004912 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004913 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Cst);
4914 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004915
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004916 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() || CI->isNullValue()) {
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00004917 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004918
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004919 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
Zhou Shengb3a80b12007-03-29 08:15:12 +00004920 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004921 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004922
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004923 Instruction *AndI =
4924 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
4925 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
4926 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004927 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And,
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004928 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt));
4929 }
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004930 }
4931 }
4932 break;
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00004933
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004934 case Instruction::SDiv:
4935 case Instruction::UDiv:
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004936 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004937 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
4938 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
4939 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
4940 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
4941 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004942 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004943 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
4944 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
4945 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
4946 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
4947 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
4948 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
4949 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
4950 // if it finds it.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004951 bool DivIsSigned = LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
4952 if (!I.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != I.isSignedPredicate())
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004953 break;
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004954 if (DivRHS->isZero())
4955 break; // Don't hack on div by zero
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004956
4957 // Initialize the variables that will indicate the nature of the
4958 // range check.
4959 bool LoOverflow = false, HiOverflow = false;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004960 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
4961
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004962 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
4963 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
4964 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
4965 // instead of computing a divide.
4966 ConstantInt *Prod =
4967 cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getMul(CI, DivRHS));
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004968
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004969 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
4970 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
4971 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004972 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
4973 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CI;
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004974
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004975 // Get the ICmp opcode
4976 ICmpInst::Predicate predicate = I.getPredicate();
Chris Lattnera92af962004-10-11 19:40:04 +00004977
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004978 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004979 LoBound = Prod;
4980 LoOverflow = ProdOV;
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004981 HiOverflow = ProdOV ||
4982 AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Reid Spencer450434e2007-03-19 20:58:18 +00004983 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004984 if (CI->isNullValue()) { // (X / pos) op 0
4985 // Can't overflow.
4986 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
4987 HiBound = DivRHS;
Reid Spencer450434e2007-03-19 20:58:18 +00004988 } else if (CI->getValue().isPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004989 LoBound = Prod;
4990 LoOverflow = ProdOV;
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004991 HiOverflow = ProdOV ||
4992 AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004993 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
4994 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
4995 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004996 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true);
4997 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004998 HiOverflow = ProdOV;
4999 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005000 } else { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005001 if (CI->isNullValue()) { // (X / neg) op 0
5002 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5003 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner73bcba52005-06-17 02:05:55 +00005004 if (HiBound == DivRHS)
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005005 LoBound = 0; // - INTMIN = INTMIN
Reid Spencer450434e2007-03-19 20:58:18 +00005006 } else if (CI->getValue().isPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005007 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5008 if (!LoOverflow)
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00005009 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS),
5010 true);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005011 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5012 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
5013 LoBound = Prod;
5014 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
5015 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getSub(Prod, DivRHS));
5016 }
Chris Lattner0b41e862004-10-08 19:15:44 +00005017
Chris Lattnera92af962004-10-11 19:40:04 +00005018 // Dividing by a negate swaps the condition.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005019 predicate = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(predicate);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005020 }
5021
5022 if (LoBound) {
5023 Value *X = LHSI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005024 switch (predicate) {
5025 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5026 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005027 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005028 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005029 else if (HiOverflow)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005030 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5031 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005032 else if (LoOverflow)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005033 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5034 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005035 else
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005036 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned,
5037 true, I);
5038 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005039 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005040 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005041 else if (HiOverflow)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005042 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5043 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005044 else if (LoOverflow)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005045 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5046 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005047 else
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005048 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned,
5049 false, I);
5050 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5051 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005052 if (LoOverflow)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005053 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005054 return new ICmpInst(predicate, X, LoBound);
5055 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5056 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005057 if (HiOverflow)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005058 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005059 if (predicate == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
5060 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5061 else
5062 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005063 }
5064 }
5065 }
5066 break;
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00005067 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005068
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005069 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005070 if (I.isEquality()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005071 bool isICMP_NE = I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00005072
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005073 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
5074 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005075 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5076 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005077 case Instruction::SRem:
5078 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005079 if (CI->isZero() && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005080 BO->hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005081 APInt V(cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue());
5082 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00005083 Value *NewRem = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createURem(
5084 BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1), BO->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005085 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), NewRem,
5086 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
Chris Lattner23b47b62004-07-06 07:38:18 +00005087 }
Chris Lattner22d00a82005-08-02 19:16:58 +00005088 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005089 break;
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005090 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner6e079362004-06-27 22:51:36 +00005091 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
5092 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerb121ae12004-09-21 21:35:23 +00005093 if (BO->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005094 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5095 ConstantExpr::getSub(CI, BOp1C));
Chris Lattner6e079362004-06-27 22:51:36 +00005096 } else if (CI->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005097 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
5098 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
5099 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005100
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005101 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005102 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005103 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005104 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00005105 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005106 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::createNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005107 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005108 Neg->takeName(BO);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005109 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005110 }
5111 }
5112 break;
5113 case Instruction::Xor:
5114 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
5115 // the explicit xor.
5116 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005117 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5118 ConstantExpr::getXor(CI, BOC));
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005119
5120 // FALLTHROUGH
5121 case Instruction::Sub:
5122 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005123 if (CI->isZero())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005124 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5125 BO->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005126 break;
5127
5128 case Instruction::Or:
5129 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
5130 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005131 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerc8e7e292004-06-10 02:12:35 +00005132 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(CI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00005133 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005134 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5135 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005136 }
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005137 break;
5138
5139 case Instruction::And:
5140 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00005141 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
5142 // comparison can never succeed!
Chris Lattnerc8e7e292004-06-10 02:12:35 +00005143 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(CI,
5144 ConstantExpr::getNot(BOC))->isNullValue())
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005145 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5146 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005147
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00005148 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
Chris Lattneree59d4b2004-06-10 02:33:20 +00005149 if (CI == BOC && isOneBitSet(CI))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005150 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
5151 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,
5152 Constant::getNullValue(CI->getType()));
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00005153
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005154 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005155 if (isSignBit(BOC)) {
5156 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005157 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
5158 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5159 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5160 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005161 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005162
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00005163 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00005164 if (CI->isNullValue() && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
5165 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00005166 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005167 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5168 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
5169 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00005170 }
5171
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00005172 }
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005173 default: break;
5174 }
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005175 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencer6bba6c82007-04-01 07:35:23 +00005176 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
5177 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
5178 AddToWorkList(II);
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005179 I.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
Reid Spencer6bba6c82007-04-01 07:35:23 +00005180 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(CI->getValue().byteSwap()));
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005181 return &I;
5182 }
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005183 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005184 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
5185 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size, then
5186 // since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00005187 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
5188 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
5189 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005190 unsigned SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00005191 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005192 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005193 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
5194 // smaller constant values.
5195 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5196 default: break;
5197 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: { // X u< 128 => X s> -1
5198 ConstantInt *CUI = cast<ConstantInt>(CI);
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005199 if (CUI->getValue() == APInt::getSignBit(SrcTySize))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005200 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005201 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005202 break;
5203 }
5204 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: { // X u> 127 => X s< 0
5205 ConstantInt *CUI = cast<ConstantInt>(CI);
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005206 if (CUI->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005207 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
5208 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
5209 break;
5210 }
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00005211 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005212
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00005213 }
5214 }
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00005215 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005216 }
5217
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005218 // Handle icmp with constant RHS
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005219 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5220 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5221 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnera816eee2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005222 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5223 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005224 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattnera816eee2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005225 bool isAllZeros = true;
5226 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5227 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5228 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5229 isAllZeros = false;
5230 break;
5231 }
5232 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005233 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera816eee2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005234 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5235 }
5236 break;
5237
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005238 case Instruction::PHI:
5239 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5240 return NV;
5241 break;
5242 case Instruction::Select:
5243 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5244 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5245 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5246 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5247 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5248 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5249 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005250 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5251 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5252 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5253 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5254 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005255 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5256 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005257 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5258 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5259 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5260 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5261 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005262 }
5263 }
Jeff Cohen82639852005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005264
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005265 if (Op1)
5266 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
5267 break;
5268 }
5269 }
5270
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005271 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005272 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005273 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005274 return NI;
5275 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005276 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5277 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005278 return NI;
5279
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005280 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005281 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5282 // now.
5283 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5284 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5285 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005286 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5287 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005288 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005289
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005290 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5291 // so eliminate it as well.
5292 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5293 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005294
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005295 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005296 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType())
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005297 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005298 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005299 } else {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005300 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00005301 Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005302 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005303 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005304 }
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005305 }
5306
5307 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005308 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005309 // This comes up when you have code like
5310 // int X = A < B;
5311 // if (X) ...
5312 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005313 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5314 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005315 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005316 return R;
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005317 }
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005318
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005319 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner17c7c032007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005320 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5321 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5322 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5323 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5324 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5325 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5326 }
5327
5328 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5329 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5330 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5331 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5332 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
5333 Constant *NC = ConstantExpr::getXor(C1, C2);
5334 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(C, NC, "tmp");
5335 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5336 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5337 }
5338
5339 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5340 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5341 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5342 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5343 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5344 }
5345 }
5346
5347 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5348 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005349 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5350 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005351 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5352 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner17c7c032007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005353 }
5354 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005355 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005356 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5357 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner17c7c032007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005358 }
5359 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005360 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005361 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5362 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005363 }
Chris Lattnerd12a4bf2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005364
Chris Lattnerd12a4bf2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005365 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5366 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5367 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5368 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5369 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5370
5371 if (A == C) {
5372 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5373 } else if (A == D) {
5374 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5375 } else if (B == C) {
5376 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5377 } else if (B == D) {
5378 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5379 }
5380
5381 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
5382 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5383 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
5384 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5385 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5386 return &I;
5387 }
5388 }
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005389 }
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005390 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005391}
5392
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005393// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005394// We only handle extending casts so far.
5395//
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005396Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
5397 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005398 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
5399 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005400 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005401 Value *RHSCIOp;
5402
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005403 // We only handle extension cast instructions, so far. Enforce this.
5404 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
5405 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattner03f06f12005-01-17 03:20:02 +00005406 return 0;
5407
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005408 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
5409 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005410
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005411 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005412 // Not an extension from the same type?
5413 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005414 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
5415 return 0;
Chris Lattner387bf3f2007-01-13 23:11:38 +00005416
5417 // If the signedness of the two compares doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
5418 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
5419 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
5420 return 0;
5421
5422 // Likewise, if the signedness of the [sz]exts and the compare don't match,
5423 // then we can't handle this.
5424 if (isSignedExt != isSignedCmp && !ICI.isEquality())
5425 return 0;
5426
5427 // Okay, just insert a compare of the reduced operands now!
5428 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer279fa252004-11-28 21:31:15 +00005429 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005430
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005431 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
5432 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5433 if (!CI)
5434 return 0;
5435
5436 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
5437 // reextended to DestTy.
5438 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
5439 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
5440
5441 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
5442 if (Res2 == CI) {
5443 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
5444 // For example, we might have:
5445 // %A = sext short %X to uint
5446 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
5447 // It is incorrect to transform this into
5448 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
5449 // because %A may have negative value.
5450 //
5451 // However, it is OK if SrcTy is bool (See cast-set.ll testcase)
5452 // OR operation is EQ/NE.
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005453 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || SrcTy == Type::Int1Ty || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005454 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
5455 else
5456 return 0;
5457 }
5458
5459 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
5460 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
5461
5462 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
5463 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
5464 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005465 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005466 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005467 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005468
5469 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
5470 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
5471 Value *Result;
5472 if (isSignedCmp) {
5473 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005474 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005475 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005476 else
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005477 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005478 } else {
5479 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
5480 if (isSignedExt) {
5481 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
5482 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005483 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005484 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
5485 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
5486 } else {
5487 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005488 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005489 }
5490 }
5491
5492 // Finally, return the value computed.
5493 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5494 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) {
5495 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
5496 } else {
5497 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
5498 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
5499 "ICmp should be folded!");
5500 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5501 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
5502 else
5503 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Result);
5504 }
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005505}
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005506
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005507Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
5508 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5509}
5510
5511Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5512 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5513}
5514
5515Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5516 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5517}
5518
5519Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
5520 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005521 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005522
5523 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
5524 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005525 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00005526 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
5527 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerf5b4ef72006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005528
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005529 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
5530 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner67f05452004-10-16 23:28:04 +00005531 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005532 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005533 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
5534 }
5535 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005536 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
5537 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
5538 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005539 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005540 }
5541
Chris Lattnerd4dee402006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005542 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
5543 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005544 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerd4dee402006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005545 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005546 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
5547
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005548 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5549 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
5550 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005551 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005552 return R;
5553
Chris Lattnerb18dbbf2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005554 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005555 if (I.isArithmeticShift()) {
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005556 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
5557 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()))) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005558 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Chris Lattnerb18dbbf2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005559 }
5560 }
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005561
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005562 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005563 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
5564 return Res;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005565 return 0;
5566}
5567
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005568Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005569 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005570 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005571
Chris Lattnerf5b4ef72006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005572 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5573 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005574 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5575 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
5576 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattnerf5b4ef72006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005577 KnownZero, KnownOne))
5578 return &I;
5579
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005580 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
5581 // of a signed value.
5582 //
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00005583 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattnerd5fea612007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005584 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005585 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5586 else {
Chris Lattnerd5fea612007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005587 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005588 return &I;
Chris Lattnerf5ce2542004-02-23 20:30:06 +00005589 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005590 }
5591
5592 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
5593 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
5594 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
5595 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5596 return BinaryOperator::createMul(BO->getOperand(0),
5597 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
5598
5599 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5600 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
5601 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
5602 return R;
5603 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5604 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5605 return NV;
5606
5607 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005608 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5609 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
5610 Value *V1, *V2;
5611 ConstantInt *CC;
5612 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005613 default: break;
5614 case Instruction::Add:
5615 case Instruction::And:
5616 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005617 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005618 // These operators commute.
5619 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005620 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
5621 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005622 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005623 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005624 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005625 Op0BO->getName());
5626 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005627 Instruction *X =
5628 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
5629 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005630 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00005631 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng5e60a4a2007-03-30 05:45:18 +00005632 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
5633 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005634 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005635
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005636 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005637 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerfe53cf22007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005638 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005639 match(Op0BOOp1,
5640 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattnerfe53cf22007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005641 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5642 V2 == Op1) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005643 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005644 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
5645 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005646 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5647 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005648 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005649 V1->getName()+".mask");
5650 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5651
5652 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
5653 }
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005654 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005655
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005656 // FALL THROUGH.
5657 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005658 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005659 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5660 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005661 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005662 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005663 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5664 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005665 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005666 Instruction *X =
Chris Lattner1df0e982006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005667 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005668 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005669 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00005670 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng5e60a4a2007-03-30 05:45:18 +00005671 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
5672 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005673 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005674
Chris Lattner1df0e982006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005675 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005676 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5677 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
5678 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005679 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005680 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
5681 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005682 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005683 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5684 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005685 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5686 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005687 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005688 V1->getName()+".mask");
5689 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5690
Chris Lattner1df0e982006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005691 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005692 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005693
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005694 break;
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005695 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005696 }
5697
5698
5699 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
5700 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
5701 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
5702 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
5703 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
5704
5705 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005706 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner44bd3922004-10-08 03:46:20 +00005707 case Instruction::Add:
5708 isValid = isLeftShift;
5709 break;
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005710 case Instruction::Or:
5711 case Instruction::Xor:
5712 highBitSet = false;
5713 break;
5714 case Instruction::And:
5715 highBitSet = true;
5716 break;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005717 }
5718
5719 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
5720 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
5721 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
5722 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
5723 // operation.
5724 //
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005725 if (isValid && !isLeftShift && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Zhou Sheng23f7a1c2007-03-28 15:02:20 +00005726 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005727 }
5728
5729 if (isValid) {
5730 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
5731
5732 Instruction *NewShift =
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005733 BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005734 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005735 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005736
5737 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
5738 NewRHS);
5739 }
5740 }
5741 }
5742 }
5743
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005744 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005745 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
5746 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
5747 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005748
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005749 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005750 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00005751 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5752 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005753 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
5754 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
5755 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005756
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005757 unsigned AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005758 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
5759 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005760
5761 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
5762
5763 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner6c344e52007-02-03 23:28:07 +00005764 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005765 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), X,
5766 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
5767 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
5768 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
5769 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
5770 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
5771 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
5772 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5773 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
5774 Instruction *Shift =
5775 BinaryOperator::createAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
5776 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5777
Zhou Sheng23f7a1c2007-03-28 15:02:20 +00005778 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005779 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005780 }
5781
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005782 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
5783 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
5784 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
5785 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
5786 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00005787 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005788 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005789 }
5790 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
5791 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Shenge9ebd3f2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00005792 APInt Mask(Ty->getMask().lshr(ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005793 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005794 }
5795 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
5796 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
5797 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
5798 // generators.
5799 const Type *SExtType = 0;
5800 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Sheng23f7a1c2007-03-28 15:02:20 +00005801 case 1 :
5802 case 8 :
5803 case 16 :
5804 case 32 :
5805 case 64 :
5806 case 128:
5807 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
5808 break;
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005809 default: break;
5810 }
5811 if (SExtType) {
5812 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
5813 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
5814 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
5815 }
5816 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
5817 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
5818 unsigned ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005819
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005820 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005821 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
5822 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
5823 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattner9cbfbc22006-01-07 01:32:28 +00005824 Instruction *Shift =
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005825 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattner9cbfbc22006-01-07 01:32:28 +00005826 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5827
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00005828 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
5829 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005830 }
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005831
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005832 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005833 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5834 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
5835 Instruction *Shift =
5836 BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
5837 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005838
Reid Spencer769a5a82007-03-26 17:18:58 +00005839 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005840 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005841 }
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005842
5843 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
5844 } else {
5845 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
5846 unsigned ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
5847
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005848 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005849 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
5850 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
5851 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
5852 Instruction *Shift =
5853 BinaryOperator::create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
5854 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
5855 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5856
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00005857 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005858 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005859 }
5860
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005861 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005862 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5863 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
5864 Instruction *Shift =
5865 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
5866 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5867
Reid Spencer441486c2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00005868 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005869 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005870 }
5871
5872 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005873 }
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005874 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005875 return 0;
5876}
5877
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00005878
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005879/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
5880/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
5881/// X*Scale+Offset.
5882///
5883static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
5884 unsigned &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005885 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005886 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005887 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
5888 Scale = 1;
5889 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005890 } else if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val)) {
5891 if (I->getNumOperands() == 2) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005892 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005893 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
5894 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
5895 Scale = 1U << CUI->getZExtValue();
5896 Offset = 0;
5897 return I->getOperand(0);
5898 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
5899 // This value is scaled by 'CUI'.
5900 Scale = CUI->getZExtValue();
5901 Offset = 0;
5902 return I->getOperand(0);
5903 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
5904 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
5905 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
5906 unsigned SubScale;
5907 Value *SubVal =
5908 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
5909 Offset += CUI->getZExtValue();
5910 if (SubScale > 1 && (Offset % SubScale == 0)) {
5911 Scale = SubScale;
5912 return SubVal;
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005913 }
5914 }
5915 }
5916 }
5917 }
5918
5919 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
5920 Scale = 1;
5921 Offset = 0;
5922 return Val;
5923}
5924
5925
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005926/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
5927/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
5928Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(CastInst &CI,
5929 AllocationInst &AI) {
5930 const PointerType *PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerbb171802005-10-27 05:53:56 +00005931 if (!PTy) return 0; // Not casting the allocation to a pointer type.
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005932
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00005933 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
5934 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner99c6cf62007-02-15 22:52:10 +00005935
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00005936 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
5937 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
5938 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
5939 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
5940 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
5941
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00005942 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00005943 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattner51f54572007-03-02 19:59:19 +00005944 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00005945 }
5946 }
5947
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005948 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
5949 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
5950 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
5951 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner355ecc02005-10-24 06:26:18 +00005952
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00005953 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
5954 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner355ecc02005-10-24 06:26:18 +00005955 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
5956
Chris Lattner46705b22005-10-24 06:35:18 +00005957 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
5958 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
5959 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
5960 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
5961
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005962 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(AllocElTy);
5963 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattnerbb171802005-10-27 05:53:56 +00005964 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner355ecc02005-10-24 06:26:18 +00005965
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00005966 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
5967 // size argument.
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005968 unsigned ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset;
5969 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
5970 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
5971
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00005972 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
5973 // do the xform.
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005974 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
5975 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattnerb3ecf962005-10-27 06:12:00 +00005976
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00005977 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
5978 Value *Amt = 0;
5979 if (Scale == 1) {
5980 Amt = NumElements;
5981 } else {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005982 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005983 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
5984 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005985 Amt = ConstantExpr::getMul(
5986 cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
5987 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00005988 else if (Scale != 1) {
5989 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
5990 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattnerb3ecf962005-10-27 06:12:00 +00005991 }
Chris Lattnerbb171802005-10-27 05:53:56 +00005992 }
5993
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005994 if (unsigned Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005995 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset);
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005996 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
5997 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
5998 }
5999
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006000 AllocationInst *New;
6001 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006002 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006003 else
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006004 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006005 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006006 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner46705b22005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006007
6008 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6009 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6010 // die soon.
6011 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6012 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006013 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6014 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6015 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner46705b22005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006016 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6017 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6018 }
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006019 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6020}
6021
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006022/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006023/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6024/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6025/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6026/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6027///
6028/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6029/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
6030static bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006031 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006032 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6033 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
6034 return true;
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006035
6036 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006037 if (!I) return false;
6038
6039 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006040
6041 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006042 case Instruction::Add:
6043 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006044 case Instruction::And:
6045 case Instruction::Or:
6046 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006047 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006048 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
6049 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, NumCastsRemoved) &&
6050 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006051
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006052 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006053 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6054 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
6055 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
6056 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006057 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6058 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6059 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006060 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty,NumCastsRemoved);
6061 }
6062 break;
6063 case Instruction::LShr:
6064 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6065 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
6066 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
6067 // already zeros.
6068 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006069 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
6070 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6071 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006072 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006073 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
6074 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006075 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, NumCastsRemoved);
6076 }
6077 }
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006078 break;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006079 case Instruction::Trunc:
6080 case Instruction::ZExt:
6081 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006082 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
6083 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
6084 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
Chris Lattner3fda3862006-06-28 17:34:50 +00006085 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
6086 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
6087 // casts first.
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00006088 if (isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner3fda3862006-06-28 17:34:50 +00006089 return true;
6090
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006091 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6092 return true;
6093 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006094 break;
6095 default:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006096 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6097 break;
6098 }
6099
6100 return false;
6101}
6102
6103/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
6104/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
6105/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006106Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006107 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006108 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006109 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006110
6111 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
6112 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerd0622b62006-05-20 23:14:03 +00006113 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006114 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006115 case Instruction::Add:
6116 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006117 case Instruction::And:
6118 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006119 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006120 case Instruction::AShr:
6121 case Instruction::LShr:
6122 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006123 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006124 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
6125 Res = BinaryOperator::create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
6126 LHS, RHS, I->getName());
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006127 break;
6128 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006129 case Instruction::Trunc:
6130 case Instruction::ZExt:
6131 case Instruction::SExt:
6132 case Instruction::BitCast:
6133 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
6134 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because its not new.
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006135 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
6136 return I->getOperand(0);
6137
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006138 // Some other kind of cast, which shouldn't happen, so just ..
6139 // FALL THROUGH
6140 default:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006141 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6142 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
6143 break;
6144 }
6145
6146 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
6147}
6148
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006149/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
6150Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner55d4bda2003-06-23 21:59:52 +00006151 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6152
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006153 // Casting undef to anything results in undef so might as just replace it and
6154 // get rid of the cast.
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006155 if (isa<UndefValue>(Src)) // cast undef -> undef
6156 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, UndefValue::get(CI.getType()));
6157
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006158 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If its eliminable we just
6159 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006160 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006161 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
6162 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
6163 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
6164 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
6165 return CastInst::create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner650b6da2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00006166 }
6167 }
Chris Lattner03841652004-05-25 04:29:21 +00006168
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00006169 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
6170 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
6171 //
Chris Lattner55d4bda2003-06-23 21:59:52 +00006172 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00006173 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
6174 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
6175 if (!isa<Constant>(GEP->getOperand(i)) ||
6176 !cast<Constant>(GEP->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
6177 AllZeroOperands = false;
6178 break;
6179 }
6180 if (AllZeroOperands) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006181 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
6182 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
6183 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00006184 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
6185 return &CI;
6186 }
6187 }
Chris Lattnerec45a4c2006-11-21 17:05:13 +00006188
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00006189 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
6190 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00006191 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006192 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
6193 return V;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00006194
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006195 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006196 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
6197 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
6198 return NV;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006199
6200 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006201 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
6202 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
6203 return NV;
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006204
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006205 return 0;
6206}
6207
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006208/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
6209/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006210/// cases.
6211/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
6212Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6213 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6214 return Result;
6215
6216 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6217 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6218 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
6219 unsigned SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6220 unsigned DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6221
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006222 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
6223 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006224 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
6225 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006226 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6227 return &CI;
6228
6229 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
6230 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006231 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
6232 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006233 return 0;
6234
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006235 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006236 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006237 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
6238 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
6239 NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006240 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
6241 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a noop-cast
6242 // this just removes a noop cast which isn't pointful, but simplifies
6243 // the code. If this is a zero-extension, we need to do an AND to
6244 // maintain the clear top-part of the computation, so we require that
6245 // the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this is a sign
6246 // extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
6247 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006248 bool DoXForm;
6249 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6250 default:
6251 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
6252 // get here because of the check above.
6253 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
6254 case Instruction::Trunc:
6255 DoXForm = true;
6256 break;
6257 case Instruction::ZExt:
6258 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
6259 break;
6260 case Instruction::SExt:
6261 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
6262 break;
6263 case Instruction::BitCast:
6264 DoXForm = false;
6265 break;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006266 }
6267
6268 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006269 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
6270 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006271 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
6272 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6273 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
6274 case Instruction::Trunc:
6275 case Instruction::BitCast:
6276 // Just replace this cast with the result.
6277 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6278 case Instruction::ZExt: {
6279 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
6280 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Zhou Sheng2777a312007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006281 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize));
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006282 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Res, C);
6283 }
6284 case Instruction::SExt:
6285 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
6286 return CastInst::create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006287 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
6288 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006289 }
6290 }
6291 }
6292
6293 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
6294 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
6295
6296 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6297 case Instruction::Add:
6298 case Instruction::Mul:
6299 case Instruction::And:
6300 case Instruction::Or:
6301 case Instruction::Xor:
6302 // If we are discarding information, or just changing the sign,
6303 // rewrite.
6304 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
6305 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6306 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6307 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
6308 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006309 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
6310 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00006311 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006312 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6313 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
6314 return BinaryOperator::create(
6315 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006316 }
6317 }
6318
6319 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
6320 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
6321 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006322 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006323 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006324 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006325 return BinaryOperator::createXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
6326 }
6327 break;
6328 case Instruction::SDiv:
6329 case Instruction::UDiv:
6330 case Instruction::SRem:
6331 case Instruction::URem:
6332 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
6333 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
6334 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6335 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6336 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006337 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
6338 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006339 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6340 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6341 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6342 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006343 return BinaryOperator::create(
6344 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
6345 }
6346 }
6347 break;
6348
6349 case Instruction::Shl:
6350 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
6351 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
6352 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
6353 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
6354 // in the value.
6355 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
6356 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006357 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
6358 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
6359 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006360 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006361 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006362 }
6363 break;
6364 case Instruction::AShr:
6365 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
6366 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
6367 // simplifications.
6368 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
6369 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006370 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006371 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
6372 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006373 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006374 }
6375 }
6376 break;
6377
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006378 case Instruction::ICmp:
6379 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and casting it
6380 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006381 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
6382 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006383 APInt Op1CV(Op1C->getValue());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006384 // cast (X == 0) to int --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6385 // cast (X == 0) to int --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6386 // cast (X == 1) to int --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6387 // cast (X == 2) to int --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6388 // cast (X != 0) to int --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6389 // cast (X != 0) to int --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6390 // cast (X != 1) to int --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6391 // cast (X != 2) to int --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006392 if (Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006393 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006394 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
6395 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6396 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006397 ComputeMaskedBits(Op0, TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006398
6399 // This only works for EQ and NE
6400 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI)->getPredicate();
6401 if (pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_NE && pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6402 break;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006403
Zhou Sheng0900993e2007-03-23 03:13:21 +00006404 APInt KnownZeroMask(KnownZero ^ TypeMask);
6405 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006406 bool isNE = pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Zhou Sheng0900993e2007-03-23 03:13:21 +00006407 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006408 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
6409 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006410 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006411 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006412 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6413 }
6414
Zhou Sheng0900993e2007-03-23 03:13:21 +00006415 unsigned ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006416 Value *In = Op0;
6417 if (ShiftAmt) {
6418 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
6419 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
6420 In = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006421 BinaryOperator::createLShr(In,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006422 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
6423 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006424 }
6425
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006426 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006427 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6428 In = BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One, "tmp");
6429 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
6430 }
6431
6432 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
6433 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6434 else
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006435 return CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006436 }
6437 }
6438 }
6439 break;
6440 }
6441 return 0;
6442}
6443
6444Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006445 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6446 return Result;
6447
6448 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6449 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
6450 unsigned DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006451 unsigned SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006452
6453 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
6454 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6455 default: break;
6456 case Instruction::LShr:
6457 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
6458 // are already zeros.
6459 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengfd28a332007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006460 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006461
6462 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Sheng2777a312007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006463 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006464 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
6465 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006466 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
6467 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
6468
6469 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
6470 // shift.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006471 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
6472 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
6473 Ty, CI);
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006474 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006475 }
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006476 } else { // This is a variable shr.
6477
6478 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
6479 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
6480 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006481 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006482 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
6483
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006484 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006485 BinaryOperator::createShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006486 "tmp"), CI);
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006487 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(V,
6488 SrcI->getOperand(0),
6489 "tmp"), CI);
6490 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006491 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006492 }
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006493 }
6494 break;
6495 }
6496 }
6497
6498 return 0;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006499}
6500
6501Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(CastInst &CI) {
6502 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
6503 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6504 return Result;
6505
6506 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6507
6508 // If this is a cast of a cast
6509 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006510 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
6511 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
6512 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
6513 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
6514 // Get the sizes of the types involved
6515 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
6516 unsigned SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6517 unsigned MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6518 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6519 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
6520 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
6521 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Sheng2777a312007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006522 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006523 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006524 Instruction *And =
6525 BinaryOperator::createAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
6526 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
6527 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
6528 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
6529 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006530 And = CastInst::createIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006531 }
6532 return And;
6533 }
6534 }
6535 }
6536
6537 return 0;
6538}
6539
6540Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(CastInst &CI) {
6541 return commonIntCastTransforms(CI);
6542}
6543
6544Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
6545 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6546}
6547
6548Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
6549 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6550}
6551
6552Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencerad05ee92006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006553 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006554}
6555
6556Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencerad05ee92006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006557 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006558}
6559
6560Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
6561 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6562}
6563
6564Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
6565 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6566}
6567
6568Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencerad05ee92006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006569 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006570}
6571
6572Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI) {
6573 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6574}
6575
6576Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(CastInst &CI) {
6577
6578 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
6579 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
6580 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6581 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6582 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
6583
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00006584 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006585 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6586 return Result;
6587 } else {
6588 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6589 return Result;
6590 }
6591
6592
6593 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
6594 // be replaced by the operand.
6595 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
6596 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
6597
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006598 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent to
6599 // a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate getelementptr.
6600 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006601 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
6602 if (const PointerType *SrcPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
6603 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
6604 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006605
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006606 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006607 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006608 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
6609 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
6610 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
6611 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006612 ++NumZeros;
6613 }
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006614
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006615 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006616 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
Chris Lattner416a8932007-01-31 20:08:52 +00006617 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
6618 return new GetElementPtrInst(Src, &Idxs[0], Idxs.size());
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006619 }
6620 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006621 }
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +00006622
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006623 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
6624 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
6625 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
6626 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00006627 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
6628 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006629 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
6630 CastInst *Tmp;
6631 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
6632 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
6633 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
6634 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
6635 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
6636 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
6637 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006638 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6639 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
6640 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6641 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006642 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
6643 // know the vector types match #elts.
6644 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner99155be2006-05-25 23:24:33 +00006645 }
6646 }
6647 }
6648 }
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00006649 return 0;
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00006650}
6651
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006652/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
6653/// %C = or %A, %B
6654/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
6655/// into:
6656/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
6657/// %D = or %A, %C
6658///
6659/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
6660/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
6661/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
6662///
6663static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
6664 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
6665 case Instruction::Add:
6666 case Instruction::Mul:
6667 case Instruction::And:
6668 case Instruction::Or:
6669 case Instruction::Xor:
6670 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
6671 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
6672 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00006673 case Instruction::LShr:
6674 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006675 return 1;
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006676 default:
6677 return 0; // Cannot fold
6678 }
6679}
6680
6681/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
6682/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
6683static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
6684 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
6685 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
6686 case Instruction::Add:
6687 case Instruction::Sub:
6688 case Instruction::Or:
6689 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006690 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00006691 case Instruction::LShr:
6692 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006693 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006694 case Instruction::And:
6695 return ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
6696 case Instruction::Mul:
6697 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
6698 }
6699}
6700
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006701/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
6702/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
6703Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
6704 Instruction *FI) {
6705 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
6706 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
6707 // merge.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006708 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006709 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
6710 return 0;
6711 } else {
6712 return 0; // unknown unary op.
6713 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006714
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006715 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
6716 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
6717 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
6718 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006719 return CastInst::create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
6720 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006721 }
6722
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006723 // Only handle binary operators here.
6724 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006725 return 0;
6726
6727 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
6728 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
6729 bool MatchIsOpZero;
6730 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
6731 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
6732 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
6733 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
6734 MatchIsOpZero = true;
6735 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
6736 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
6737 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
6738 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
6739 MatchIsOpZero = false;
6740 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
6741 return 0;
6742 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
6743 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
6744 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
6745 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
6746 MatchIsOpZero = true;
6747 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
6748 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
6749 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
6750 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
6751 MatchIsOpZero = true;
6752 } else {
6753 return 0;
6754 }
6755
6756 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
6757 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
6758 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
6759 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
6760
6761 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
6762 if (MatchIsOpZero)
6763 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
6764 else
6765 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006766 }
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006767 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
6768 return 0;
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006769}
6770
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00006771Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00006772 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
6773 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
6774 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
6775
6776 // select true, X, Y -> X
6777 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006778 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006779 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00006780
6781 // select C, X, X -> X
6782 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
6783 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6784
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006785 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
6786 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6787 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
6788 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6789 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
6790 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
6791 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6792 else
6793 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6794 }
6795
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006796 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00006797 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006798 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006799 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006800 return BinaryOperator::createOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006801 } else {
6802 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
6803 Value *NotCond =
6804 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
6805 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006806 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006807 }
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00006808 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006809 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006810 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006811 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006812 } else {
6813 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
6814 Value *NotCond =
6815 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
6816 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006817 return BinaryOperator::createOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006818 }
6819 }
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006820 }
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006821
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006822 // Selecting between two integer constants?
6823 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
6824 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
6825 // select C, 1, 0 -> cast C to int
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006826 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006827 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006828 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006829 // select C, 0, 1 -> cast !C to int
6830 Value *NotCond =
6831 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattnercf7baf32004-04-09 18:19:44 +00006832 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006833 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnercf7baf32004-04-09 18:19:44 +00006834 }
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006835
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006836 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006837
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006838 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
6839 // (x >u 2147483647) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006840 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006841 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
6842 bool CanXForm = false;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006843 if (IC->isSignedPredicate())
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006844 CanXForm = CmpCst->isZero() &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006845 IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006846 else {
6847 unsigned Bits = CmpCst->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006848 CanXForm = CmpCst->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Bits) &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006849 IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006850 }
6851
6852 if (CanXForm) {
6853 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006854 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006855 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006856 unsigned Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006857 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
6858 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, X,
6859 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006860 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
6861
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006862 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
6863 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
6864 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
6865 unsigned SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6866 unsigned SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6867 if (SRASize < SISize)
6868 opc = Instruction::SExt;
6869 else if (SRASize > SISize)
6870 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
6871 return CastInst::create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006872 }
6873 }
6874
6875
6876 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006877 // have a fcmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006878 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
6879 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006880 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00006881 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006882 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
6883 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
6884 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006885 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
6886 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
6887 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006888 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
6889 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006890 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
6891 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006892 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006893 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006894 Value *V = ICA;
6895 if (ShouldNotVal)
6896 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::create(
6897 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
6898 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
6899 }
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006900 }
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00006901 }
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006902
6903 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006904 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
6905 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006906 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006907 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006908 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6909 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006910 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006911 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6912 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
6913
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006914 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006915 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006916 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattner24cf0202004-04-11 01:39:19 +00006917 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006918 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006919 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
6920 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6921 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
6922 }
6923 }
6924
6925 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
6926 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
6927 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
6928 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
6929 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6930 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6931 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
6932 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6933 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6934 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
6935
6936 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
6937 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
6938 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6939 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6940 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
6941 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattner24cf0202004-04-11 01:39:19 +00006942 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006943 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
6944 }
6945 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006946
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00006947 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
6948 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
6949 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00006950 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
6951
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006952 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
6953 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
6954 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
6955 return IV;
6956
6957 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
6958 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00006959 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
6960 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6961 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
6962 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
6963 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6964 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
6965 }
6966
6967 if (AddOp) {
6968 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
6969 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
6970 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
6971 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
6972 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
6973 }
6974
6975 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattnerb580d262006-02-24 18:05:58 +00006976 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
6977 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
6978 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
6979 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
6980 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
6981 } else {
6982 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
6983 BinaryOperator::createNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00006984 }
Chris Lattnerb580d262006-02-24 18:05:58 +00006985
6986 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
6987 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
6988 if (AddOp != TI)
6989 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
6990 Instruction *NewSel =
6991 new SelectInst(CondVal, NewTrueOp,NewFalseOp,SI.getName()+".p");
6992
6993 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
6994 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00006995 }
6996 }
6997 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006998
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006999 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007000 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007001 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
7002 // transformation we are doing here.
7003 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7004 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7005 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
7006 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
7007 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7008 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
7009 OpToFold = 1;
7010 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
7011 OpToFold = 2;
7012 }
7013
7014 if (OpToFold) {
7015 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007016 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007017 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007018 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007019 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007020 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
7021 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007022 else {
7023 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
7024 }
7025 }
7026 }
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00007027
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007028 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7029 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7030 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7031 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
7032 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7033 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
7034 OpToFold = 1;
7035 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
7036 OpToFold = 2;
7037 }
7038
7039 if (OpToFold) {
7040 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007041 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007042 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), C, FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007043 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007044 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007045 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
7046 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007047 else
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007048 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007049 }
7050 }
7051 }
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00007052
7053 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
7054 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
7055 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
7056 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
7057 return &SI;
7058 }
7059
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007060 return 0;
7061}
7062
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007063/// GetKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that we can
7064/// determine, return it, otherwise return 0.
7065static unsigned GetKnownAlignment(Value *V, TargetData *TD) {
7066 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V)) {
7067 unsigned Align = GV->getAlignment();
7068 if (Align == 0 && TD)
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007069 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(GV->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007070 return Align;
7071 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
7072 unsigned Align = AI->getAlignment();
7073 if (Align == 0 && TD) {
7074 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007075 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007076 else if (isa<MallocInst>(AI)) {
7077 // Malloc returns maximally aligned memory.
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007078 Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007079 Align =
7080 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007081 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::DoubleTy));
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007082 Align =
7083 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007084 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::Int64Ty));
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007085 }
7086 }
7087 return Align;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007088 } else if (isa<BitCastInst>(V) ||
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007089 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007090 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)) {
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007091 User *CI = cast<User>(V);
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007092 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
7093 return GetKnownAlignment(CI->getOperand(0), TD);
7094 return 0;
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007095 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V) ||
7096 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
7097 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode()==Instruction::GetElementPtr)) {
7098 User *GEPI = cast<User>(V);
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007099 unsigned BaseAlignment = GetKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0), TD);
7100 if (BaseAlignment == 0) return 0;
7101
7102 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
7103 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
7104 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
7105 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i)) ||
7106 !cast<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
7107 AllZeroOperands = false;
7108 break;
7109 }
7110 if (AllZeroOperands)
7111 return BaseAlignment;
7112
7113 // Otherwise, if the base alignment is >= the alignment we expect for the
7114 // base pointer type, then we know that the resultant pointer is aligned at
7115 // least as much as its type requires.
7116 if (!TD) return 0;
7117
7118 const Type *BasePtrTy = GEPI->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007119 const PointerType *PtrTy = cast<PointerType>(BasePtrTy);
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007120 if (TD->getABITypeAlignment(PtrTy->getElementType())
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007121 <= BaseAlignment) {
7122 const Type *GEPTy = GEPI->getType();
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007123 const PointerType *GEPPtrTy = cast<PointerType>(GEPTy);
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007124 return TD->getABITypeAlignment(GEPPtrTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007125 }
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007126 return 0;
7127 }
7128 return 0;
7129}
7130
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007131
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007132/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
7133/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
7134/// the heavy lifting.
7135///
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007136Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007137 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
7138 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
7139
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007140 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
7141 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007142 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007143 bool Changed = false;
7144
7145 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
7146 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
7147 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7148
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007149 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007150 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007151 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
7152 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
7153 // alignment is sufficient.
7154 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007155 }
7156
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007157 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
7158 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
7159 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007160 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(II)) {
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007161 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
7162 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
7163 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner681ef2f2006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007164 const char *Name;
Andrew Lenharth0ebb0b02006-11-03 22:45:50 +00007165 if (CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType()->getParamType(2) ==
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007166 Type::Int32Ty)
Chris Lattner681ef2f2006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007167 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i32";
7168 else
7169 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i64";
Chris Lattnerfbc524f2007-01-07 06:58:05 +00007170 Constant *MemCpy = M->getOrInsertFunction(Name,
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007171 CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType());
7172 CI.setOperand(0, MemCpy);
7173 Changed = true;
7174 }
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007175 }
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007176
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007177 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
7178 // set, update the alignment.
7179 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
7180 unsigned Alignment1 = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1), TD);
7181 unsigned Alignment2 = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2), TD);
7182 unsigned Align = std::min(Alignment1, Alignment2);
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007183 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Align) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007184 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Align));
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007185 Changed = true;
7186 }
7187 } else if (isa<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
7188 unsigned Alignment = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getDest(), TD);
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007189 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007190 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007191 Changed = true;
7192 }
7193 }
7194
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007195 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner503221f2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007196 } else {
7197 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
7198 default: break;
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007199 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
7200 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
Chris Lattner36dd7c92006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007201 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
7202 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
7203 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
7204 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
7205 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007206 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD) >= 16) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007207 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007208 PointerType::get(II->getType()), CI);
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007209 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
7210 }
7211 break;
7212 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
7213 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
7214 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
7215 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), TD) >= 16) {
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007216 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007217 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(2),
7218 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007219 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
7220 }
7221 break;
Chris Lattner36dd7c92006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007222 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
7223 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
7224 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
7225 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storel_dq:
7226 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
7227 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD) >= 16) {
7228 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007229 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
7230 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattner36dd7c92006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007231 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
7232 }
7233 break;
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007234
7235 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
7236 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
7237 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
7238 uint64_t UndefElts;
7239 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
7240 UndefElts)) {
7241 II->setOperand(1, V);
7242 return II;
7243 }
7244 break;
7245 }
7246
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007247 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
7248 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007249 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007250 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
7251
7252 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
7253 bool AllEltsOk = true;
7254 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7255 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
7256 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
7257 AllEltsOk = false;
7258 break;
7259 }
7260 }
7261
7262 if (AllEltsOk) {
7263 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007264 Value *Op0 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7265 II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType(), CI);
7266 Value *Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7267 II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType(), CI);
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007268 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
7269
7270 // Only extract each element once.
7271 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
7272 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
7273
7274 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7275 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
7276 continue;
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007277 unsigned Idx =cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007278 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
7279
7280 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
7281 Instruction *Elt =
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007282 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007283 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
7284 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
7285 }
7286
7287 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007288 Result = new InsertElementInst(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx], i,"tmp");
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007289 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
7290 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007291 return CastInst::create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007292 }
7293 }
7294 break;
7295
Chris Lattner503221f2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007296 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
7297 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
7298 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
7299 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
7300 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
7301 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
7302 if (&*++BI == II)
7303 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7304 }
7305 }
7306
7307 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
7308 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
7309 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
7310 if (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)) {
7311 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
7312 bool CannotRemove = false;
7313 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
7314 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) ||
7315 (isa<CallInst>(BI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BI))) {
7316 CannotRemove = true;
7317 break;
7318 }
7319 }
7320 if (!CannotRemove)
7321 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7322 }
7323 break;
7324 }
7325 }
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007326 }
7327
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007328 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007329}
7330
7331// InvokeInst simplification
7332//
7333Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007334 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007335}
7336
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007337// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
7338//
7339Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007340 bool Changed = false;
7341
7342 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
7343 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007344 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
7345
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007346 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007347
Chris Lattner61d9d812005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007348 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
7349 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
7350 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
7351 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
7352 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007353 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007354 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), OldCall);
Chris Lattner61d9d812005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007355 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
7356 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
7357 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
7358 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
7359 return 0;
7360 }
7361
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007362 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
7363 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
7364 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
7365 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007366 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007367 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007368 CS.getInstruction());
7369
7370 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
7371 CS.getInstruction()->
7372 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
7373
7374 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
7375 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
7376 new BranchInst(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007377 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007378 }
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007379 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
7380 }
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007381
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007382 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
7383 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
7384 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
7385 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
7386 // the call.
7387 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
7388 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I)
7389 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I)) {
7390 // If this cast does not effect the value passed through the varargs
7391 // area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
7392 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007393 if (CI->isLosslessCast()) {
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007394 *I = Op;
7395 Changed = true;
7396 }
7397 }
7398 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007399
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007400 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007401}
7402
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007403// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
7404// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
7405//
7406bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
7407 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
7408 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007409 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
7410 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007411 return false;
Reid Spencer87436872004-07-18 00:38:32 +00007412 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007413 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
7414
7415 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
7416 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
7417 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
7418 //
7419 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
7420 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
7421
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007422 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
7423 if (OldRetTy != FT->getReturnType()) {
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007424 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !Caller->use_empty() &&
Chris Lattner7051d752007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007425 // Conversion is ok if changing from pointer to int of same size.
7426 !(isa<PointerType>(FT->getReturnType()) &&
7427 TD->getIntPtrType() == OldRetTy))
Chris Lattner400f9592007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007428 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007429
7430 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
7431 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
7432 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
7433 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
7434 if (!Caller->use_empty())
7435 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
7436 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
7437 UI != E; ++UI)
7438 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
7439 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattnerfae8ab32004-02-08 21:44:31 +00007440 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007441 return false;
7442 }
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007443
7444 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
7445 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007446
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007447 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
7448 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
7449 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthebfa24e2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007450 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007451 ConstantInt *c = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(*AI);
Andrew Lenharthebfa24e2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007452 //Either we can cast directly, or we can upconvert the argument
Chris Lattner400f9592007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007453 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Chris Lattner7051d752007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007454 (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) && isa<PointerType>(ActTy)) ||
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007455 (ParamTy->isInteger() && ActTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer8f166b02007-01-08 16:32:00 +00007456 ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ||
7457 (c && ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()
Zhou Sheng222d5eb2007-03-25 05:01:29 +00007458 && c->getValue().isStrictlyPositive());
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007459 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007460 }
7461
7462 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007463 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007464 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body...
7465
7466 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
7467 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
7468 std::vector<Value*> Args;
7469 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
7470
7471 AI = CS.arg_begin();
7472 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
7473 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
7474 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
7475 Args.push_back(*AI);
7476 } else {
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007477 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007478 false, ParamTy, false);
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007479 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007480 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007481 }
7482 }
7483
7484 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
7485 // now...
7486 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
7487 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
7488
7489 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
7490 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs)
7491 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlingf3baad32006-12-07 01:30:32 +00007492 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
7493 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007494 } else {
7495 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
7496 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
7497 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
7498 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
7499 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007500 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
7501 PTy, false);
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007502 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007503 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
7504 Args.push_back(Cast);
7505 } else {
7506 Args.push_back(*AI);
7507 }
7508 }
7509 }
7510
7511 if (FT->getReturnType() == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007512 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007513
7514 Instruction *NC;
7515 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Chris Lattnerfae8ab32004-02-08 21:44:31 +00007516 NC = new InvokeInst(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Chris Lattnera06a8fd2007-02-13 02:10:56 +00007517 &Args[0], Args.size(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattner05c703e2005-05-14 12:25:32 +00007518 cast<InvokeInst>(II)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007519 } else {
Chris Lattnera06a8fd2007-02-13 02:10:56 +00007520 NC = new CallInst(Callee, &Args[0], Args.size(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattner6aacb0f2005-05-06 06:48:21 +00007521 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
7522 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Chris Lattner05c703e2005-05-14 12:25:32 +00007523 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007524 }
7525
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007526 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007527 Value *NV = NC;
7528 if (Caller->getType() != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
7529 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007530 const Type *CallerTy = Caller->getType();
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007531 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
7532 CallerTy, false);
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007533 NV = NC = CastInst::create(opcode, NC, CallerTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner686767f2003-10-30 00:46:41 +00007534
7535 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
7536 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
7537 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
7538 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->begin();
7539 while (isa<PHINode>(I)) ++I;
7540 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
7541 } else {
7542 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
7543 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
7544 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007545 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007546 } else {
Chris Lattnere29d6342004-10-17 21:22:38 +00007547 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007548 }
7549 }
7550
7551 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
7552 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattner51f54572007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007553 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00007554 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007555 return true;
7556}
7557
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007558/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
7559/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
7560/// and a single binop.
7561Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
7562 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007563 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
7564 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007565 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007566 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
7567 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
7568
7569 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
7570 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007571
7572 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
7573 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnerdc826fc2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00007574 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007575 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnerdc826fc2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00007576 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007577 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007578 // types or GEP's with different index types.
7579 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
7580 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007581 return 0;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007582
7583 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
7584 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
7585 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
7586 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
7587 return 0;
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007588
7589 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
7590 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
7591 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007592 }
7593
Chris Lattner4f218d52006-11-08 19:42:28 +00007594 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
7595
7596 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
7597 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
7598 // hide them behind a phi.
7599 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
7600 return 0;
7601
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007602 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007603 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner4f218d52006-11-08 19:42:28 +00007604 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007605 if (LHSVal == 0) {
7606 NewLHS = new PHINode(LHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName()+".pn");
7607 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
7608 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007609 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
7610 LHSVal = NewLHS;
7611 }
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007612
7613 if (RHSVal == 0) {
7614 NewRHS = new PHINode(RHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName()+".pn");
7615 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
7616 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007617 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
7618 RHSVal = NewRHS;
7619 }
7620
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007621 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
7622 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7623 if (NewLHS) {
7624 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
7625 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
7626 }
7627 if (NewRHS) {
7628 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
7629 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
7630 }
7631 }
7632
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007633 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007634 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007635 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
7636 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
7637 RHSVal);
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007638 else {
7639 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
7640 return new GetElementPtrInst(LHSVal, RHSVal);
7641 }
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007642}
7643
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007644/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
7645/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
7646/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
7647/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerc9042052007-02-01 22:30:07 +00007648///
7649/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
7650/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
7651/// to a register.
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007652static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
7653 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
7654
7655 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
7656 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
7657 return false;
Chris Lattnerc9042052007-02-01 22:30:07 +00007658
7659 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
7660 // profitable to do this xform.
7661 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
7662 bool isAddressTaken = false;
7663 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
7664 UI != E; ++UI) {
7665 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
7666 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
7667 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
7668 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
7669 }
7670 isAddressTaken = true;
7671 break;
7672 }
7673
7674 if (!isAddressTaken)
7675 return false;
7676 }
7677
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007678 return true;
7679}
7680
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007681
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007682// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
7683// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
7684// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
7685Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
7686 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
7687
7688 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
7689 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
7690 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
7691 // code size and simplifying code.
7692 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
7693 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007694 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007695 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
7696 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007697 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007698 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
7699 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007700 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007701 if (ConstantOp == 0)
7702 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007703 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
7704 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
7705 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
7706 // load and the PHI.
7707 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
7708 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
7709 return 0;
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007710 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner4f218d52006-11-08 19:42:28 +00007711 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007712 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
7713 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
7714 return 0;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007715 } else {
7716 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
7717 }
7718
7719 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
7720 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7721 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
7722 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007723 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007724 return 0;
7725 if (CastSrcTy) {
7726 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
7727 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007728 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007729 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
7730 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007731 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
7732 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
7733 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
7734 return 0;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007735 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
7736 return 0;
7737 }
7738 }
7739
7740 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
7741 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
7742 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
7743 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattnerd8e20182005-01-29 00:39:08 +00007744 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00007745
7746 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
7747 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007748
7749 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00007750 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7751 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
7752 if (NewInVal != InVal)
7753 InVal = 0;
7754 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
7755 }
7756
7757 Value *PhiVal;
7758 if (InVal) {
7759 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
7760 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
7761 PhiVal = InVal;
7762 delete NewPN;
7763 } else {
7764 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
7765 PhiVal = NewPN;
7766 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007767
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007768 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007769 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
7770 return CastInst::create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00007771 else if (isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007772 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007773 else if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00007774 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007775 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
7776 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
7777 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007778 else
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007779 assert(0 && "Unknown operation");
Jeff Cohenb622c112007-03-05 00:00:42 +00007780 return 0;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007781}
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007782
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007783/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
7784/// that is dead.
Chris Lattnerd2602d52007-03-26 20:40:50 +00007785static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
7786 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007787 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
7788 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
7789
7790 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattnerd2602d52007-03-26 20:40:50 +00007791 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007792 return true;
7793
7794 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
7795 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007796
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007797 return false;
7798}
7799
Chris Lattnerbbbdd852002-05-06 18:06:38 +00007800// PHINode simplification
7801//
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007802Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonbbf89902006-07-10 22:15:25 +00007803 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattner8258b442007-03-04 04:27:24 +00007804 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersona6968f82006-07-10 19:03:49 +00007805
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007806 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
7807 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
7808
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007809 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
7810 // reducing code size.
7811 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
7812 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
7813 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
7814 return Result;
7815
7816 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
7817 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
7818 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerc8dcede2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00007819 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
7820 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
7821 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattnerd2602d52007-03-26 20:40:50 +00007822 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007823 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
7824 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
7825 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
7826 }
Chris Lattnerc8dcede2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00007827
7828 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
7829 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
7830 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
7831 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
7832 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
7833 // late.
7834 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
7835 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
7836 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
7837 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
7838 }
7839 }
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007840
Chris Lattner91daeb52003-12-19 05:58:40 +00007841 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbbbdd852002-05-06 18:06:38 +00007842}
7843
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007844static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
7845 Instruction *InsertPoint,
7846 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer8f166b02007-01-08 16:32:00 +00007847 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7848 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007849 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
7850 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
7851 // used for address computation.
7852 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
7853 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
7854 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
7855 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007856}
7857
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007858
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007859Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007860 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner471bd762003-05-22 19:07:21 +00007861 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, long 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007862 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007863 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007864 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007865
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007866 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
7867 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
7868
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007869 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
7870 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
7871 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
7872
7873 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007874 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007875
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00007876 // Keep track of whether all indices are zero constants integers.
7877 bool AllZeroIndices = true;
7878
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007879 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
7880 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00007881
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00007882 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00007883 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
7884 // Track whether this GEP has all zero indices, if so, it doesn't move the
7885 // input pointer, it just changes its type.
7886 if (AllZeroIndices) {
7887 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(i)))
7888 AllZeroIndices = CI->isNullValue();
7889 else
7890 AllZeroIndices = false;
7891 }
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00007892 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
7893 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(GEP.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattner27df1db2007-01-15 07:02:54 +00007894 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
7895 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
7896 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
7897 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
7898 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
7899 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
7900 MadeChange = true;
7901 GEP.setOperand(i, CI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007902 }
7903 }
7904 }
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00007905 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
7906 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
7907 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
7908 // obvious.
7909 Value *Op = GEP.getOperand(i);
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007910 if (TD->getTypeSize(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSize())
Chris Lattner1e9ac1a2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00007911 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007912 GEP.setOperand(i, ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner1e9ac1a2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00007913 MadeChange = true;
7914 } else {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007915 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
7916 GEP);
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00007917 GEP.setOperand(i, Op);
7918 MadeChange = true;
7919 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007920 }
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00007921 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007922 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
7923
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00007924 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
7925 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
7926 // real input to the dest type.
7927 if (AllZeroIndices && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
7928 return new BitCastInst(cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))->getOperand(0),
7929 GEP.getType());
7930
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00007931 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
7932 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
7933 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
7934 //
Chris Lattneraf6094f2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00007935 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00007936 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattneraf6094f2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00007937 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00007938
7939 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007940 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
7941 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
7942 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
7943 //
7944 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
7945 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
7946 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
7947
Chris Lattneraf6094f2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00007948 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007949
7950 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
7951 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
7952 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
7953 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattner8ec5f882004-05-08 22:41:42 +00007954 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007955
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00007956 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007957 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattner235af562003-03-05 22:33:14 +00007958 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
7959 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
7960 //
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007961 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007962 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
7963 Sum = GO1;
7964 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
7965 Sum = SO1;
7966 } else {
7967 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
7968 // target's pointer size.
7969 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
7970 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007971 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007972 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007973 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007974 } else {
7975 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSize();
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007976 if (TD->getTypeSize(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007977 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007978 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007979
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007980 } else if (TD->getTypeSize(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007981 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007982 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007983 } else {
7984 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007985 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
7986 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007987 }
7988 }
7989 }
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007990 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
7991 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
7992 else {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007993 Sum = BinaryOperator::createAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
7994 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007995 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007996 }
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007997
7998 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
7999 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
8000 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
8001 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
8002 return &GEP;
8003 } else {
8004 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8005 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
8006 Indices.push_back(Sum);
8007 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
8008 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008009 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008010 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008011 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008012 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008013 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8014 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008015 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
8016 }
8017
8018 if (!Indices.empty())
Chris Lattnera7315132007-02-12 22:56:41 +00008019 return new GetElementPtrInst(SrcGEPOperands[0], &Indices[0],
8020 Indices.size(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008021
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008022 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008023 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
8024 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
8025
8026 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008027 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008028 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
8029 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
8030 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
8031
8032 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008033 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
8034 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008035
8036 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
8037 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
8038 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008039 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008040 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
8041 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
8042 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
8043 // transform: GEP (cast [10 x ubyte]* X to [0 x ubyte]*), long 0, ...
8044 // into : GEP [10 x ubyte]* X, long 0, ...
8045 //
8046 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
8047 //
8048 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
8049 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
8050 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
8051 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
8052 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
8053 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
8054 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
8055 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
8056 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
8057 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
8058 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
8059 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
8060 return &GEP;
8061 }
8062 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
8063 // Transform things like:
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008064 // %t = getelementptr ubyte* cast ([2 x int]* %str to uint*), uint %V
8065 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x int*]* %str, int 0, uint %V; cast
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008066 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
8067 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
8068 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
8069 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
8070 TD->getTypeSize(ResElTy)) {
8071 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008072 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty),
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008073 GEP.getOperand(1), GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008074 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
8075 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008076 }
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008077
8078 // Transform things like:
8079 // getelementptr sbyte* cast ([100 x double]* X to sbyte*), int %tmp
8080 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
8081 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, int 0, int %tmp.2
8082
8083 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008084 (ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty || ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty)) {
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008085 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
8086 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
8087
8088 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
8089 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
8090 Value *NewIdx = 0;
8091 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
8092 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
8093 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
8094 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
8095 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnera393e4d2005-09-14 17:32:56 +00008096 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008097 Scale = CI;
8098 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
8099 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
8100 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Shengb25806f2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00008101 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8102 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
8103 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008104 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8105 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
8106 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
8107 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8108 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8109 }
8110 }
8111
8112 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
8113 // out, perform the transformation.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008114 if (Scale && Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008115 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Scale))
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008116 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
8117 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
8118 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008119 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
8120 true /*SExt*/);
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008121 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::createMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
8122 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
8123 }
8124
8125 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008126 Instruction *NewGEP =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008127 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty),
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008128 NewIdx, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008129 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
8130 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
8131 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008132 }
8133 }
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008134 }
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008135 }
8136
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008137 return 0;
8138}
8139
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008140Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
8141 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
8142 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) // Check C != 1
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008143 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8144 const Type *NewTy =
8145 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008146 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008147
8148 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
8149 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman848622f2005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008150 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008151 else {
8152 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman848622f2005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008153 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008154 }
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008155
8156 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008157
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008158 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
8159 // allocas if possible...
8160 //
8161 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
8162 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
8163
8164 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
8165 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
8166 //
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008167 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattner809dfac2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00008168 Value *V = new GetElementPtrInst(New, NullIdx, NullIdx,
8169 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008170
8171 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
8172 // allocation.
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008173 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008174 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8175 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008176 }
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008177
8178 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
8179 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
8180 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008181 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Chris Lattner49df6ce2004-07-02 22:55:47 +00008182 TD->getTypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008183 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
8184
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008185 return 0;
8186}
8187
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008188Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
8189 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
8190
8191 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
8192 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op))
8193 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
8194 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
8195 return &FI;
8196 }
8197
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008198 // free undef -> unreachable.
8199 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
8200 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008201 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008202 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008203 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
8204 }
8205
Chris Lattnerf3a36602004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008206 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
8207 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008208 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008209 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattnerf3a36602004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008210
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008211 return 0;
8212}
8213
8214
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008215/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008216static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI) {
8217 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008218 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008219
8220 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008221 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008222 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008223
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008224 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008225 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008226 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8227 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8228 // constants.
8229 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8230 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8231 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008232 Value *Idxs[2];
8233 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8234 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008235 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8236 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8237 }
8238
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008239 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008240 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerecfa9b52005-03-29 06:37:47 +00008241 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
8242 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
8243 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008244 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8245 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008246
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008247 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
8248 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
8249 // the result of the loaded value.
8250 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
8251 CI->getName(),
8252 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
8253 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008254 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008255 }
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008256 }
8257 }
8258 return 0;
8259}
8260
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008261/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008262/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
8263/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
8264/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
8265static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
8266 // If it is an alloca or global variable, it is always safe to load from.
8267 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V) || isa<GlobalVariable>(V)) return true;
8268
8269 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
8270 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008271 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
8272 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
8273 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008274 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
8275
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008276 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008277 --BBI;
8278
8279 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
8280 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
8281 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8282 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008283
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008284 }
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008285 return false;
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008286}
8287
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008288Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
8289 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7e8af382004-01-12 04:13:56 +00008290
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008291 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008292 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008293 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8294 return Res;
8295
8296 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
8297 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008298
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008299 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
8300 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattnere0bfdf12005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008301 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
8302 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008303 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8304 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
8305 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnere0bfdf12005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008306 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
8307 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
8308 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008309 }
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008310
8311 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op))
8312 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI->getOperand(0)) ||
8313 isa<UndefValue>(GEPI->getOperand(0))) {
8314 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
8315 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
8316 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
8317 // CFG.
8318 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8319 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
8320 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
8321 }
8322
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008323 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008324 // load null/undef -> undef
8325 if ((C->isNullValue() || isa<UndefValue>(C))) {
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008326 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
8327 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
8328 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008329 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8330 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008331 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008332 }
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008333
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008334 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
8335 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008336 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008337 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008338
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008339 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
8340 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
8341 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
8342 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008343 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner0b011ec2005-09-26 05:28:06 +00008344 if (Constant *V =
8345 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008346 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008347 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
8348 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
8349 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
8350 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
8351 // CFG.
8352 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8353 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
8354 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
8355 }
8356
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008357 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008358 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8359 return Res;
8360 }
8361 }
Chris Lattnere228ee52004-04-08 20:39:49 +00008362
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008363 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008364 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
8365 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
8366 // exposes redundancy in the code.
8367 //
8368 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
8369 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
8370 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
8371 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
8372 // unconditionally.
8373 //
8374 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
8375 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008376 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
8377 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008378 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner42618552004-09-20 10:15:10 +00008379 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008380 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner42618552004-09-20 10:15:10 +00008381 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008382 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
8383 }
8384
Chris Lattnerbdcf41a2004-09-23 15:46:00 +00008385 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
8386 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
8387 if (C->isNullValue()) {
8388 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
8389 return &LI;
8390 }
8391
8392 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
8393 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
8394 if (C->isNullValue()) {
8395 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
8396 return &LI;
8397 }
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008398 }
8399 }
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008400 return 0;
8401}
8402
Reid Spencere928a152007-01-19 21:20:31 +00008403/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008404/// when possible.
8405static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
8406 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
8407 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
8408
8409 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
8410 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
8411 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8412
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008413 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008414 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8415 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8416 // constants.
8417 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8418 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8419 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008420 Value* Idxs[2];
8421 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8422 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008423 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8424 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8425 }
8426
Reid Spencer9a4bed02007-01-20 23:35:48 +00008427 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
8428 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8429 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008430
8431 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008432 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
8433 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008434 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008435 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008436 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
8437 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
8438 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
8439 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
8440 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008441 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer9a4bed02007-01-20 23:35:48 +00008442 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008443 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008444 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
8445 }
8446 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008447 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008448 else
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008449 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008450 CastInst::create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
8451 SI);
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008452 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
8453 }
8454 }
8455 }
8456 return 0;
8457}
8458
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008459Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
8460 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
8461 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
8462
8463 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008464 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008465 ++NumCombined;
8466 return 0;
8467 }
Chris Lattnera4beeef2007-01-15 06:51:56 +00008468
8469 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
8470 // alloca dead.
8471 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
8472 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
8473 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8474 ++NumCombined;
8475 return 0;
8476 }
8477
8478 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
8479 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
8480 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
8481 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8482 ++NumCombined;
8483 return 0;
8484 }
8485 }
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008486
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008487 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
8488 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
8489 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
8490 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
8491 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
8492 --ScanInsts) {
8493 --BBI;
8494
8495 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
8496 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
8497 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
8498 ++NumDeadStore;
8499 ++BBI;
8500 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
8501 continue;
8502 }
8503 break;
8504 }
8505
Chris Lattnerdab43b22006-05-26 19:19:20 +00008506 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
8507 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
8508 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
8509 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
8510 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr) {
8511 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8512 ++NumCombined;
8513 return 0;
8514 }
8515 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
8516 // may not be dead.
8517 break;
8518 }
8519
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008520 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattnerdab43b22006-05-26 19:19:20 +00008521 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008522 break;
8523 }
8524
8525
8526 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008527
8528 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
8529 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
8530 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
8531 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
8532 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008533 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008534 ++NumCombined;
8535 }
8536 return 0; // Do not modify these!
8537 }
8538
8539 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
8540 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008541 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008542 ++NumCombined;
8543 return 0;
8544 }
8545
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008546 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
8547 // source instead.
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008548 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008549 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
8550 return Res;
8551 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008552 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008553 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
8554 return Res;
8555
Chris Lattner219175c2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00008556
8557 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
8558 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008559 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner219175c2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00008560 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
8561 if (BI->isUnconditional()) {
8562 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
8563 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
8564 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
8565 BasicBlock *Dest = BI->getSuccessor(0);
8566
8567 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(Dest);
8568 BasicBlock *Other = 0;
8569 if (*PI != BI->getParent())
8570 Other = *PI;
8571 ++PI;
8572 if (PI != pred_end(Dest)) {
8573 if (*PI != BI->getParent())
8574 if (Other)
8575 Other = 0;
8576 else
8577 Other = *PI;
8578 if (++PI != pred_end(Dest))
8579 Other = 0;
8580 }
8581 if (Other) { // If only one other pred...
8582 BBI = Other->getTerminator();
8583 // Make sure this other block ends in an unconditional branch and that
8584 // there is an instruction before the branch.
8585 if (isa<BranchInst>(BBI) && cast<BranchInst>(BBI)->isUnconditional() &&
8586 BBI != Other->begin()) {
8587 --BBI;
8588 StoreInst *OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
8589
8590 // If this instruction is a store to the same location.
8591 if (OtherStore && OtherStore->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
8592 // Okay, we know we can perform this transformation. Insert a PHI
8593 // node now if we need it.
8594 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
8595 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
8596 PHINode *PN = new PHINode(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
8597 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
8598 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
8599 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), Other);
8600 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, Dest->front());
8601 }
8602
8603 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
8604 // insert it.
8605 BBI = Dest->begin();
8606 while (isa<PHINode>(BBI)) ++BBI;
8607 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
8608 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
8609
8610 // Nuke the old stores.
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008611 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8612 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
Chris Lattner219175c2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00008613 ++NumCombined;
8614 return 0;
8615 }
8616 }
8617 }
8618 }
8619
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008620 return 0;
8621}
8622
8623
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +00008624Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
8625 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +00008626 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00008627 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
8628 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
8629 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
8630 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
8631 // Swap Destinations and condition...
8632 BI.setCondition(X);
8633 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
8634 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
8635 return &BI;
8636 }
8637
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008638 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
8639 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
8640 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
8641 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
8642 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
8643 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
8644 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008645 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008646 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
8647 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008648 // Swap Destinations and condition...
8649 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
8650 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
8651 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008652 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008653 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008654 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008655 return &BI;
8656 }
8657
8658 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
8659 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
8660 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
8661 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
8662 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
8663 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
8664 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
8665 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008666 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008667 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
8668 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00008669 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00008670 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00008671 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
8672 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008673 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008674 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008675 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00008676 return &BI;
8677 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008678
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +00008679 return 0;
8680}
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008681
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +00008682Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
8683 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
8684 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
8685 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
8686 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
8687 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
8688 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008689 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +00008690 AddRHS));
8691 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008692 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +00008693 return &SI;
8694 }
8695 }
8696 return 0;
8697}
8698
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008699/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
8700/// is to leave as a vector operation.
8701static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
8702 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
8703 return true;
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008704 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008705 if (isConstant) return true;
8706 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
8707 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
8708 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
8709 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
8710 return false;
8711 return true;
8712 }
8713 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
8714 if (!I) return false;
8715
8716 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
8717 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
8718 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
8719 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
8720 return true;
8721 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
8722 return true;
8723 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
8724 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
8725 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
8726 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
8727 return true;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008728 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
8729 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
8730 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
8731 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
8732 return true;
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008733
8734 return false;
8735}
8736
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00008737/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
8738///
8739/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
8740/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008741static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
8742 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
8743 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
8744 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
8745 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
8746 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
8747
8748 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008749 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008750 for (unsigned i = 0, e = CP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
8751 if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i)))
8752 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
8753 else
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008754 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(CP->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008755 return Result;
8756}
8757
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008758/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
8759/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
8760/// extracted from the vector.
8761static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008762 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
8763 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner2d37f922006-04-10 23:06:36 +00008764 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
8765 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008766 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
8767
8768 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
8769 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
8770 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
8771 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008772 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008773 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
8774 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
8775 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008776 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
8777 return 0;
8778 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008779
8780 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
8781 // inserted value.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008782 if (EltNo == IIElt)
8783 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008784
8785 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
8786 // vector input.
8787 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner2d37f922006-04-10 23:06:36 +00008788 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008789 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
8790 if (InEl < Width)
8791 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
8792 else if (InEl < Width*2)
8793 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
8794 else
8795 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008796 }
8797
8798 // Otherwise, we don't know.
8799 return 0;
8800}
8801
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008802Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008803
Chris Lattner92346c32006-03-31 18:25:14 +00008804 // If packed val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
8805 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
8806 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
8807
8808 // If packed val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
8809 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
8810 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
8811
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008812 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008813 // If packed val is constant with uniform operands, replace EI
8814 // with that operand
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008815 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008816 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008817 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
8818 op0 = 0;
8819 break;
8820 }
8821 if (op0)
8822 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008823 }
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008824
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008825 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
8826 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008827 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008828 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
8829 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
8830 // property.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008831 uint64_t IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008832 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
8833 uint64_t UndefElts;
8834 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008835 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008836 UndefElts)) {
8837 EI.setOperand(0, V);
8838 return &EI;
8839 }
8840 }
8841
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008842 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008843 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattner2d37f922006-04-10 23:06:36 +00008844 }
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008845
Chris Lattner83f65782006-05-25 22:53:38 +00008846 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008847 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
8848 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
8849 // profitable to do so
8850 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008851 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
8852 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
8853 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
8854 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
8855 EI.getName()+".lhs");
8856 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
8857 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
8858 EI.getName()+".rhs");
8859 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
8860 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
8861 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
8862 }
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008863 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008864 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, I->getOperand(0),
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008865 PointerType::get(EI.getType()), EI);
8866 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
Reid Spencera736fdf2006-11-29 01:11:01 +00008867 new GetElementPtrInst(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName() + ".gep");
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008868 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
8869 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner83f65782006-05-25 22:53:38 +00008870 }
8871 }
8872 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
8873 // Extracting the inserted element?
8874 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
8875 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
8876 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
8877 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
8878 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
8879 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
8880 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
8881 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
8882 return &EI;
8883 }
8884 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
8885 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
8886 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008887 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
8888 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008889 Value *Src;
8890 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
8891 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
8892 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
8893 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
8894 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
8895 } else {
8896 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner612fa8e2006-03-30 22:02:40 +00008897 }
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008898 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008899 }
8900 }
Chris Lattner83f65782006-05-25 22:53:38 +00008901 }
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008902 return 0;
8903}
8904
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008905/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
8906/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
8907/// Otherwise, return false.
8908static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
8909 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
8910 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
8911 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008912 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008913
8914 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008915 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008916 return true;
8917 } else if (V == LHS) {
8918 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008919 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008920 return true;
8921 } else if (V == RHS) {
8922 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008923 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008924 return true;
8925 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
8926 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
8927 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
8928 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
8929 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
8930
Chris Lattnerb6cb64b2006-04-27 21:14:21 +00008931 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
8932 return false;
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008933 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerb6cb64b2006-04-27 21:14:21 +00008934
8935 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
8936 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
8937 // transitively ok.
8938 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
8939 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008940 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerb6cb64b2006-04-27 21:14:21 +00008941 return true;
8942 }
8943 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
8944 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008945 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
8946 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008947 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008948
8949 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
8950 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
8951 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
8952 // transitively ok.
8953 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
8954 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
8955 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
8956 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008957 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008958 } else {
8959 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
8960 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008961 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008962
8963 }
8964 return true;
8965 }
8966 }
8967 }
8968 }
8969 }
8970 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
8971
8972 return false;
8973}
8974
8975/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
8976/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
8977/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008978static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008979 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008980 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008981 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008982 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008983 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008984
8985 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008986 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008987 return V;
8988 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008989 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008990 return V;
8991 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
8992 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
8993 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
8994 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
8995 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
8996
8997 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
8998 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
8999 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9000 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009001 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
9002 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009003
9004 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
9005 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009006 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
9007 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
9008 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009009 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009010 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009011 return V;
9012 }
9013
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009014 if (VecOp == RHS) {
9015 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009016 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
9017 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
9018 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009019 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009020 }
9021 return V;
9022 }
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009023
9024 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
9025 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
9026 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
9027 return EI->getOperand(0);
9028
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009029 }
9030 }
9031 }
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009032 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009033
9034 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
9035 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009036 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009037 return V;
9038}
9039
9040Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
9041 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
9042 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
9043 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
9044
9045 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
9046 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
9047 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9048 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9049 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
9050 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009051 unsigned ExtractedIdx=cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
9052 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009053
9054 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
9055 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9056
9057 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
9058 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
9059
9060 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
9061 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
9062 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
9063 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9064
9065 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
9066 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
9067 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
9068 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
9069 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
9070 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
9071 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
9072 // Build a new shuffle mask.
9073 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
9074 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009075 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009076 else {
9077 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009078 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009079 NumVectorElts));
9080 }
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009081 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009082 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009083 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009084 }
9085
9086 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
9087 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
9088 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
9089 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009090 Value *RHS = 0;
9091 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
9092 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
9093 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009094 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009095 }
9096 }
9097 }
9098
9099 return 0;
9100}
9101
9102
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009103Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
9104 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9105 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009106 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009107
9108 bool MadeChange = false;
9109
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009110 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009111 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009112 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
9113
Chris Lattnerd7b6ea12007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009114 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009115 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnerd7b6ea12007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009116 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
9117 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
9118 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
9119 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9120 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
9121 Mask[i] = 2*e;
9122 MadeChange = true;
9123 }
9124 }
9125
9126 if (MadeChange) {
9127 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9128 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9129 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9130 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
9131 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
9132 else
9133 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
9134 }
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009135 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattnerd7b6ea12007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009136 }
9137 }
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009138
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009139 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
9140 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
9141 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
9142 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009143 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
9144 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9145 }
9146
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009147 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9148 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9149 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009150 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009151 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009152 else {
9153 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
9154 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS)))
9155 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
9156 else
9157 Mask[i] &= (e-1); // Force to LHS.
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009158 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009159 }
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009160 }
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009161 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009162 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009163 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009164 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9165 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009166 MadeChange = true;
9167 }
9168
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009169 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009170 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner34cebe72006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009171
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009172 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9173 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
9174 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
9175 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
9176
9177 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
9178 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner34cebe72006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009179 }
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009180
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009181 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
9182 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9183 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009184
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009185 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
9186 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
9187 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
9188 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
9189 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
9190 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
9191 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
9192 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
9193 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
9194 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
9195 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
9196 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
9197
9198 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
9199 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
9200 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
9201 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
9202 else
9203 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
9204
9205 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
9206 // the replacement.
9207 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
9208 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9209 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9210 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009211 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009212 } else {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009213 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009214 }
9215 }
9216 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
9217 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009218 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009219 }
9220 }
9221 }
Chris Lattner4284f642007-01-30 22:32:46 +00009222
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009223 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
9224}
9225
9226
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009227
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009228
9229/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
9230/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
9231/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
9232/// end of its block.
9233static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
9234 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
9235
Chris Lattnerc4f67e62005-10-27 17:13:11 +00009236 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
9237 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory()) return false;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009238
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009239 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmandcb291f2007-03-22 16:38:57 +00009240 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
9241 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009242 return false;
9243
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009244 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
9245 // the end of block that could change the value.
9246 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009247 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = LI, E = LI->getParent()->end();
9248 Scan != E; ++Scan)
9249 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
9250 return false;
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009251 }
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009252
9253 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->begin();
9254 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) ++InsertPos;
9255
Chris Lattner9f269e42005-08-08 19:11:57 +00009256 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009257 ++NumSunkInst;
9258 return true;
9259}
9260
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009261
9262/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
9263/// all reachable code to the worklist.
9264///
9265/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
9266/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
9267/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
9268/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
9269/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
9270///
9271static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner7907e5f2007-02-15 19:41:52 +00009272 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009273 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009274 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner12b89cc2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009275 std::vector<BasicBlock*> Worklist;
9276 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009277
Chris Lattner12b89cc2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009278 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
9279 BB = Worklist.back();
9280 Worklist.pop_back();
9281
9282 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
9283 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
9284
9285 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
9286 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009287
Chris Lattner12b89cc2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009288 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
9289 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
9290 ++NumDeadInst;
9291 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
9292 Inst->eraseFromParent();
9293 continue;
9294 }
9295
9296 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
9297 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
9298 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
9299 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
9300 ++NumConstProp;
9301 Inst->eraseFromParent();
9302 continue;
9303 }
9304
9305 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009306 }
Chris Lattner12b89cc2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009307
9308 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
9309 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
9310 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
9311 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
9312 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
9313 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
9314 Worklist.push_back(BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal));
9315 continue;
9316 }
9317 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
9318 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
9319 // See if this is an explicit destination.
9320 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
9321 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
9322 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(i));
9323 continue;
9324 }
9325
9326 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
9327 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
9328 continue;
9329 }
9330 }
9331
9332 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
9333 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009334 }
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009335}
9336
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009337bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009338 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00009339 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009340
9341 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
9342 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009343
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009344 {
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009345 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
9346 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
9347 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner7907e5f2007-02-15 19:41:52 +00009348 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009349 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00009350
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009351 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
9352 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
9353 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
9354 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
9355 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
9356 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
9357 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
9358 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner2d3a7a62004-04-27 15:13:33 +00009359
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009360 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009361 ++NumDeadInst;
9362
9363 if (!I->use_empty())
9364 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
9365 I->eraseFromParent();
9366 }
9367 }
9368 }
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009369
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009370 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
9371 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
9372 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009373
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009374 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009375 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009376 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009377 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009378 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009379 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009380
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009381 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00009382
9383 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009384 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009385 continue;
9386 }
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009387
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009388 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattnere3eda252007-01-30 23:16:15 +00009389 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009390 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00009391
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009392 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009393 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc6509f42002-12-05 22:41:53 +00009394 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
9395
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009396 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009397 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009398 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009399 continue;
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009400 }
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009401
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009402 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
9403 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
9404 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
9405 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
9406 if (UserParent != BB) {
9407 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
9408 // See if the user is one of our successors.
9409 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
9410 if (*SI == UserParent) {
9411 UserIsSuccessor = true;
9412 break;
9413 }
9414
9415 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
9416 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
9417 // otherwise), we can keep going.
9418 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
9419 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
9420 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
9421 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
9422 }
9423 }
9424
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009425 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencer755d0e72007-03-26 17:44:01 +00009426#ifndef NDEBUG
9427 std::string OrigI;
9428#endif
9429 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009430 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner0b18c1d2002-05-10 15:38:35 +00009431 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009432 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +00009433 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009434 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
9435 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +00009436
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009437 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
9438 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
9439
9440 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009441 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009442 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009443
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009444 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
9445 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009446
9447 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
9448 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009449 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
9450
9451 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
9452 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
9453 ++InsertPos;
9454
9455 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009456
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00009457 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
9458 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009459 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerb643a9e2004-05-01 23:19:52 +00009460
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009461 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
9462 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009463 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009464
9465 // Erase the old instruction.
9466 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009467 } else {
Evan Chenga4ed8a52007-03-27 16:44:48 +00009468#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencer755d0e72007-03-26 17:44:01 +00009469 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
9470 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chenga4ed8a52007-03-27 16:44:48 +00009471#endif
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +00009472
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009473 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
9474 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00009475 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
9476 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
9477 // use counts.
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009478 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009479
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00009480 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009481 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009482 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009483 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009484 } else {
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009485 AddToWorkList(I);
9486 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009487 }
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +00009488 }
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009489 Changed = true;
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009490 }
9491 }
9492
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009493 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009494 return Changed;
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +00009495}
9496
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009497
9498bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattner8258b442007-03-04 04:27:24 +00009499 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
9500
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009501 bool EverMadeChange = false;
9502
9503 // Iterate while there is work to do.
9504 unsigned Iteration = 0;
9505 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
9506 EverMadeChange = true;
9507 return EverMadeChange;
9508}
9509
Brian Gaeke38b79e82004-07-27 17:43:21 +00009510FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009511 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +00009512}
Brian Gaeke960707c2003-11-11 22:41:34 +00009513